Display Bezel and Display UM

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 201

®

Micro Graphic Panel

Hardware User Manual

EA1-MG-USER-M
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic
Panel

C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel Installed in a


20-button Keypad Bezel EA-MG-BZ2

C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel being Installed


in a 20-button Keypad Bezel EA-MG-BZ2

C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel Installed in a


20-button Keypad Bezel EA-MG-BZ2
showing touch function.
®
Graphic Panel
HARDWARE USER MANUAL

Please include the Manual Number and the Manual Issue, both shown below,
when communicating with Technical Support regarding this publication.

Manual Number: EA1-MG-USER-M


Issue: 2nd Edition Rev. B
Issue Date: 09/10

Publication History
Issue Date Description of Changes
1st Edition 09/06 Original issue
Rev. A 04/07 Minor corrections made and content added for AB protocol
Rev. B 05/07 Minor revisions & removal of all references to PLC Driver for Entivity Modbus RTU.
Rev. C 08/07 Added PLC Protocol for Entivity Modbus RTU, GE, Mitsubishi, Omron & Modicon.
2nd Edition 03/08 Added “white” backlight color models EA1-S3MLW and EA1-S3MLW-N.
Also added PLC protcols for Allen-Bradley DH485, GE VersaMax & Siemens PPI.
Rev. A 10/08 Added CLICK PLC information
Rev. B 09/10 Added Allen Bradley PLC DF1 imformation and made minor corrections
 WARNING 
Thank you for purchasing automation equipment from Automationdirect.com®, doing business as,
AutomationDirect. We want your new automation equipment to operate safely. Anyone who installs or
uses this equipment should read this publication (and any other relevant publications) before installing or
operating the equipment.
To minimize the risk of potential safety problems, you should follow all applicable local and national codes
that regulate the installation and operation of your equipment. These codes vary from area to area and
usually change with time. It is your responsibility to determine which codes should be followed, and to
verify that the equipment, installation, and operation is in compliance with the latest revision of these
codes.
At a minimum, you should follow all applicable sections of the National Fire Code, National Electrical
Code, and the codes of the National Electrical Manufacturer's Association (NEMA). There may be local
regulatory or government offices that can also help determine which codes and standards are necessary for
safe installation and operation.
Equipment damage or serious injury to personnel can result from the failure to follow all applicable codes
and standards. We do not guarantee the products described in this publication are suitable for your
particular application, nor do we assume any responsibility for your product design, installation, or
operation.
Our products are not fault-tolerant and are not designed, manufactured or intended for use or resale as on-
line control equipment in hazardous environments requiring fail-safe performance, such as in the
operation of nuclear facilities, aircraft navigation or communication systems, air traffic control, direct life
support machines, or weapons systems, in which the failure of the product could lead directly to death,
personal injury, or severe physical or environmental damage ("High Risk Activities"). AutomationDirect
specifically disclaims any expressed or implied warranty of fitness for High Risk Activities.
For additional warranty and safety information, see the Terms and Conditions section of our catalog. If
you have any questions concerning the installation or operation of this equipment, or if you need
additional information, please call us at 770-844-4200.
This publication is based on information that was available at the time it was printed. At
AutomationDirect we constantly strive to improve our products and services, so we reserve the right to
make changes to the products and/or publications at any time without notice and without any obligation.
This publication may also discuss features that may not be available in certain revisions of the product.

Trademarks
This publication may contain references to products produced and/or offered by other companies. The
product and company names may be trademarked and are the sole property of their respective owners.
AutomationDirect disclaims any proprietary interest in the marks and names of others.
Copyright 2006-2010, Automationdirect.com® Incorporated
All Rights Reserved
No part of this manual shall be copied, reproduced, or transmitted in any way without the prior, written
consent of Automationdirect.com® Incorporated. AutomationDirect retains the exclusive rights to all
information included in this document.
 ADVERTENCIA 
Gracias por comprar equipo de automatización de Automationdirect.com®. Deseamos que su nuevo equipo de
automatización opere de manera segura. Cualquier persona que instale o use este equipo debe leer esta
publicación (y cualquier otra publicación pertinente) antes de instalar u operar el equipo.
Para reducir al mínimo el riesgo debido a problemas de seguridad, debe seguir todos los códigos de seguridad
locales o nacionales aplicables que regulan la instalación y operación de su equipo. Estos códigos varian de área
en área y usualmente cambian con el tiempo. Es su responsabilidad determinar cuales códigos deben ser
seguidos y verificar que el equipo, instalación y operación estén en cumplimiento con la revisión mas reciente
de estos códigos.
Como mínimo, debe seguir las secciones aplicables del Código Nacional de Incendio, Código Nacional
Eléctrico, y los códigos de (NEMA) la Asociación Nacional de Fabricantes Eléctricos de USA. Puede haber
oficinas de normas locales o del gobierno que pueden ayudar a determinar cuales códigos y normas son
necesarios para una instalación y operación segura.
Si no se siguen todos los códigos y normas aplicables, puede resultar en daños al equipo o lesiones serias a
personas. No garantizamos los productos descritos en esta publicación para ser adecuados para su aplicación en
particular, ni asumimos ninguna responsabilidad por el diseño de su producto, la instalación u operación.
Nuestros productos no son tolerantes a fallas y no han sido diseñados, fabricados o intencionados para uso o
reventa como equipo de control en línea en ambientes peligrosos que requieren una ejecución sin fallas, tales
como operación en instalaciones nucleares, sistemas de navegación aérea, o de comunicación, control de tráfico
aéreo, máquinas de soporte de vida o sistemas de armamentos en las cuales la falla del producto puede resultar
directamente en muerte, heridas personales, o daños físicos o ambientales severos ("Actividades de Alto Riesgo").
Automationdirect.com específicamente rechaza cualquier garantía ya sea expresada o implicada para
actividades de alto riesgo.
Para información adicional acerca de garantía e información de seguridad, vea la sección de Términos y
Condiciones de nuestro catálogo. Si tiene alguna pregunta sobre instalación u operación de este equipo, o si
necesita información adicional, por favor llámenos al número 770-844-4200 en Estados Unidos.
Esta publicación está basada en la información disponible al momento de impresión. En
Automationdirect.com nos esforzamos constantemente para mejorar nuestros productos y servicios, así que
nos reservamos el derecho de hacer cambios al producto y/o a las publicaciones en cualquier momento sin
notificación y sin ninguna obligación. Esta publicación también puede discutir características que no estén
disponibles en ciertas revisiones del producto.

Marcas Registradas
Esta publicación puede contener referencias a productos producidos y/u ofrecidos por otras compañías. Los nombres de las
compañías y productos pueden tener marcas registradas y son propiedad única de sus respectivos dueños. Automationdirect.com,
renuncia cualquier interés propietario en las marcas y nombres de otros.
PROPIEDAD LITERARIA 2006-2010, AUTOMATIONDIRECT.COM® INCORPORATED
Todos los derechos reservados
No se permite copiar, reproducir, o transmitir de ninguna forma ninguna parte de este manual sin previo consentimiento por escrito de
Automationdirect.com® Incorprated. Automationdirect.com retiene los derechos exclusivos a toda la información incluida en este
documento. Los usuarios de este equipo pueden copiar este documento solamente para instalar, configurar y mantener el equipo
correspondiente. También las instituciones de enseñanza pueden usar este manual para propósitos educativos.
 AVERTISSEMENT 
Nous vous remercions d'avoir acheté l'équipement d'automatisation de Automationdirect.com®, en faisant des
affaires comme, AutomationDirect. Nous tenons à ce que votre nouvel équipement d'automatisation fonctionne en
toute sécurité. Toute personne qui installe ou utilise cet équipement doit lire la présente publication (et toutes les
autres publications pertinentes) avant de l'installer ou de l'utiliser.
Afin de réduire au minimum le risque d'éventuels problèmes de sécurité, vous devez respecter tous les codes locaux et
nationaux applicables régissant l'installation et le fonctionnement de votre équipement. Ces codes diffèrent d'une
région à l'autre et, habituellement, évoluent au fil du temps. Il vous incombe de déterminer les codes à respecter et
de vous assurer que l'équipement, l'installation et le fonctionnement sont conformes aux exigences de la version la
plus récente de ces codes.
Vous devez, à tout le moins, respecter toutes les sections applicables du Code national de prévention des incendies,
du Code national de l'électricité et des codes de la National Electrical Manufacturer's Association (NEMA). Des
organismes de réglementation ou des services gouvernementaux locaux peuvent également vous aider à déterminer
les codes ainsi que les normes à respecter pour assurer une installation et un fonctionnement sûrs.
L'omission de respecter la totalité des codes et des normes applicables peut entraîner des dommages à l'équipement
ou causer de graves blessures au personnel. Nous ne garantissons pas que les produits décrits dans cette publication
conviennent à votre application particulière et nous n'assumons aucune responsabilité à l'égard de la conception, de
l'installation ou du fonctionnement de votre produit.
Nos produits ne sont pas insensibles aux défaillances et ne sont ni conçus ni fabriqués pour l'utilisation ou la revente
en tant qu'équipement de commande en ligne dans des environnements dangereux nécessitant une sécurité absolue,
par exemple, l'exploitation d'installations nucléaires, les systèmes de navigation aérienne ou de communication, le
contrôle de la circulation aérienne, les équipements de survie ou les systèmes d'armes, pour lesquels la défaillance du
produit peut provoquer la mort, des blessures corporelles ou de graves dommages matériels ou environnementaux
(«activités à risque élevé»). La société AutomationDirect nie toute garantie expresse ou implicite d'aptitude à
l'emploi en ce qui a trait aux activités à risque élevé.
Pour des renseignements additionnels touchant la garantie et la sécurité, veuillez consulter la section Modalités et
conditions de notre documentation. Si vous avez des questions au sujet de l'installation ou du fonctionnement de cet
équipement, ou encore si vous avez besoin de renseignements supplémentaires, n'hésitez pas à nous téléphoner au
770-844-4200.
Cette publication s'appuie sur l'information qui était disponible au moment de l'impression. À la société
AutomationDirect, nous nous efforçons constamment d'améliorer nos produits et services. C'est pourquoi nous
nous réservons le droit d'apporter des modifications aux produits ou aux publications en tout temps, sans préavis ni
quelque obligation que ce soit. La présente publication peut aussi porter sur des caractéristiques susceptibles de ne
pas être offertes dans certaines versions révisées du produit.

Marques de commerce
La présente publication peut contenir des références à des produits fabriqués ou offerts par d'autres entreprises. Les
désignations des produits et des entreprises peuvent être des marques de commerce et appartiennent exclusivement à
leurs propriétaires respectifs. AutomationDirect nie tout intérêt dans les autres marques et désignations.
Copyright 2006-2010, Automationdirect.com® Incorporated
Tous droits réservés
Nulle partie de ce manuel ne doit être copiée, reproduite ou transmise de quelque façon que ce soit sans le
consentement préalable écrit de la société Automationdirect.com® Incorporated. AutomationDirect conserve les
droits exclusifs à l'égard de tous les renseignements contenus dans le présent document.
TABLE OF CONTENTS

Chapter 1: Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–1


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–2
Conventions Used . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–3
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–4
Agency Approvals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–5
Part Number Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–5
Product Label Examples: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–6
Serial Number and Date Code formats: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–6
Quick Start Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–7
Step 1 – Unpack and Inspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–7
Step 2 – Install Optional Hardware Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–8
Step 3 – Become Familiar with Available Communication Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–9
Step 4 – Install C-more Micro-Graphic Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–10
Step 5 – Install the Programming Software and Develop a Project . . . . . . . . . . . .1–11
Step 6 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–12
Step 7 – Provide Power to the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–13
Step 8 – Accessing the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . .1–14
Step 9 – Choose C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC Protocol & Cables . . . . . . . .1–15
Step 10 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–16

Chapter 2: Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–1


Available Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–2
Model Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–3
Panel Dimensions (all models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–5
Communications Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–6
Chemical Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–7
Table of Contents

Chapter 3: Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–1


Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–2
C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–3
USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–6
8-Button Keypad Bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–8
20-button Keypad Bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–11
DC Power Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–14
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–18
Clear Screen Overlay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–21

Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–1


Safety Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–3
Panel Cutout Dimensions (all models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–4
Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–5

Chapter 5: System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–1


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–2
Accessing the System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–3
System Setup Screens Flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–4
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–5
Information Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Extensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Versions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Setting Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–7
LCD Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–7
Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–8
Beep . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–10
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–11

ii ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Table of Contents

Clear User Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–12


Reset to Factory Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–12
Hourglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
Test Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–14
Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–14
Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–15
PLC Enquiry Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–16
Buzzer Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–16
Touch Panel Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–17
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–17

Chapter 6: PLC Communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–1


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–2
Available PLC Protocols: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
C-more Micro-Graphic Built-in Port 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–3
C-more Micro-Graphic Optional EA-MG-SP1 Port 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–4
DirectLOGIC PLCs Password Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
PLC Compatibility and Connection Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
AutomationDirect CLICK PLC: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
Direct LOGIC PLCs RS-422A/RS-485A: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–6
Allen-Bradley: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–6
GE, Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–6
Available Purchased Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–20
Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–22
User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–32
RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–40

Chapter 7: Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–1


Project Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–2
Check Operating Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–2
Check Operating Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–2
Check Transmit and Receive Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–3

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
iii
Table of Contents

Check Physical Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–3


Run Tests under the System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–4
Check Settings under the System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–5
Cleaning the Display Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–5
Check Project Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–6
Checks from the C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–6

Chapter 8: Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–1


C-more Micro-Graphic Panel does not Power up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–2
Display is Blank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–2
Display is Dim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–3
No User Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–3
Lost Firmware – Red ‘Update Mode’ Screen Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–4
No Communications between Panel and PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–5
No Communications between Panel and PLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–7
Panel & PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–8
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Runtime Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–9
Electrical Noise Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–10

Chapter 9: Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–1


Replacement Parts Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
Panel Mounting Clips – EA-MG-S3ML-BRK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
Panel Gasket – EA-MG-S3ML-GSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
8-Button Keypad Bezel Mounting Clips – EA-MG-BZ1-BRK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
8-Button Keypad Bezel Gasket – EA-MG-BZ1-GSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
20-Button Keypad Bezel Mounting Clips – EA-MG-BZ2-BRK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
20-Button Keypad Bezel Gasket – EA-MG-BZ2-GSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
DC Power Connector – EA-MG--DC-CON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
Function Keys Label Inserts – EA-MG-S3ML-FKL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
Customizing the Function Keys Label Insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–4

iv ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Table of Contents

Appendix A: PLC Protocol Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–1


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–2
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–3
Modbus Protocols Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
AutomationDirect CLICK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
AutomationDirect DirectLOGIC - Modbus (Koyo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
Modicon Modbus RTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
Entivity Modbus RTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
DirectLOGIC Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–5
DirectLOGIC – K-Sequence PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–5
DirectLOGIC – DirectNET PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–5
Allen-Bradley Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–6
Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–7
Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–9
GE Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–11
GE SNPX Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–12
Mitsubishi FX Protocol – PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–21
Mitsubishi Q / QnA and Q Series – PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–21
Omron Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–23
Omron Host Link Protocol – PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–24
Omron FINS Protocol – PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–25
Siemens Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–28
Siemens PPI Protocol – PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–29

Appendix B: Micro-Graphic Panel Runtime Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B–1


Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B–2
Runtime Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B–2

Index

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
v
CHAPTER
GETTING STARTED
1
In This Chapter...
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–2
Conventions Used . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–3
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–4
Agency Approvals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–5
Part Number Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–5
Product Label Examples: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–6
Serial Number and Date Code formats: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–6
Quick Start Steps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–7
Step 1 – Unpack and Inspect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–7
Step 2 – Install Optional Hardware Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–8
Step 3 – Become Familiar with Available Communication Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–9
Step 4 – Install C-more Micro-Graphic Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–10
Step 5 – Install the Programming Software and Develop a Project . . . . . . . . . . . .1–11
Step 6 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–12
Step 7 – Provide Power to the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–13
Step 8 – Accessing the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . .1–14
Step 9 – Choose C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC Protocol & Cables . . . . . . . .1–15
Step 10 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1–16
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Introduction
1 The Purpose of this Manual
2 Thank you for purchasing our C-more® Micro-Graphic family of products. This manual
describes AutomationDirect.com’s C-more Micro-Graphic panels, their specifications, included
components, available accessories and provides you with important information for installation,
3 connectivity and setup. The manual shows you how to install, wire and use the products. It also
helps you understand how to interface the panels to other devices in a control system.
4 This user manual contains important information for personnel who will install the panels and
accessories, and for the personnel who will be programming the panel. If you understand
5 control systems making use of operating interfaces such as the C-more Micro-Graphic panels,
our user manuals will provide all the information you need to get, and keep, your system up and
running.
6 Supplemental Manuals
If you are familiar with industrial control type devices, you may be able to get up and running
7 with just the aide of the Quick Start Guide that is included with each panel and accessory. You
may also have need to refer to the On-line help that is available in the C-more Micro-Graphic
8 programming software. The Quick Start Guide is included with each accessory that will help
with installing the accessory.
9 Technical Support
We strive to make our manuals the best in the industry. We rely on your feedback to let us know
10 if we are reaching our goal. If you cannot find the solution to your particular application, or, if
for any reason you need technical assistance, please call us at:
770–844–4200
11 Our technical support group will work with you to answer your questions. They are available
Monday through Friday from 9:00 A.M. to 6:00 P.M. Eastern Time. We also encourage you to
12 visit our web site where you can find technical and non-technical information about our
products and our company.
13 http://www.automationdirect.com
If you have a comment, question or suggestion about any of our products, services, or manuals,
14 please fill out and return the ‘Suggestions’ card that was included with this manual.

A
B
C
D

1–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Conventions Used
1
When you see the “notepad” icon in the left-hand margin, the paragraph to its immediate right will be a
2
special note. The word NOTE: in boldface will mark the beginning of the text.
3
4
When you see the “exclamation mark” icon in the left-hand margin, the paragraph to its immediate
right will be a warning. This information could prevent injury, loss of property, or even death (in
5
extreme cases). The word WARNING: in boldface will mark the beginning of the text.
6
7
Key Topics for Each Chapter 8
The beginning of each chapter will list the key topics
that can be found in that chapter. Getting Started CHAPTER 9
1
In This Chapter...
10
General Information .................................................................1-2
Specifications ...........................................................................1-4
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–3
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Product Overview
1
Touch Non
2 Screen Touch

3
4 EA1-S3ML, EA1-S3MLW* EA1-S3ML-N, EA1-S3MLW-N*
C-more Micro-Graphic 3.1-inch Panels have an STN LCD, 128 x 64 dot monochrome
5 display. Models EA1-S3ML and EA1-S3ML-N have 5 selectable backlight colors (green, red,
amber, yellow and lime). Models EA1-S3MLW and EA1-S3MLW-N have 5 selectable
backlight colors (white, pink1, pink2, pink3 and red). The panels have 5 user-defined
6 functions keys with LED indicators. The panels can display up to 10 lines by 32 characters of
static text and up to 10 lines by 21 characters of dynamic text with embedded variables and
7 phrases mixed with graphics. Power is supplied to the panel through the serial
communication port connection when used with AutomationDirect CLICK and most
8 DirectLOGIC PLC’s having a RJ12 communication port. Either EA-MG-SP1 (power supply
with serial port option module) or EA-MG-P1 is required when connecting to third party
PLC’s. NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 rated (when mounted correctly). For indoor use only.
9 Other features include:
• 768 KB memory
10 • Built in RJ12 serial communications port
• Adjustable contrast
11 • 2 optional keypad bezels, 8-button or 20-button
• 2 optional DC Power Adapters, one includes 15-pin serial communications port (RS-232/422/485)
12 • Optional replaceable clear screen overlay
• Built in Alarm Control setup that activates beep, backlight flash, customized alarm banner, and red
13 LED blinking
• Up to 999 screens, limited only by memory usage
14 • 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F) operating temperature range
• UL, cUL & CE agency approvals (see below for details)
A • 2-year warranty from date of purchase

*Note: C-more Micro-Graphic panels with the letter “W” in the part number designate units with five
B selectable background colors of White, Pink1, Pink2, Pink3 and Red. Part numbers without the letter “W”
are provided with five selectable background colors of Green, Red, Amber, Yellow and Lime.
C
*Note: Software and Firware Version 1.5 or later is required with models EA1-S3MLW and EA1-S3MLW-N.
D Available for free download at www.automationdirect.com

1–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Agency Approvals
UL/CUL/CE Certification Numbers 1
Name UL/CUL UL508 CE ISO-9000
C-more Micro-Graphic Panels
& Accessories E157382 E157382 EN61131-2 Yes 2
C UL 3
R
US
4
Part Number Key 5
The C-more Micro-Graphic panel part numbers use the following key:

Display Size: Display Color:


6
3: 3” M: Monochrome
Series No.:
Backlight Type:
7
EA1: Micro-Graphic
L: LED
Display Type:
EA1-S3MLx-x 8
S: STN
Backlight Color: Features:
9
blank: red, green, amber, lime, yellow blank: Touch Screen
W: white, pink1, pink2, pink3, red N: Non Touch Screen 10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–5
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Product Label Examples:


1
2 EA1-S3ML
EA1-S3MLW
3
4
5 EA1-S3ML-N

6 EA1-S3MLW-N
7
8 Serial Number and Date Code formats:
9 [Part Number]+[YYMDDFNNN]
Serial Number =
YYMF
Date Code =

10 YY:
M:
Year (07–99 --- e.g. 07 = 2007)
Month (1–9, X, Y, Z --- e.g. X = Oct.)
DD: Day (1–31)
11 F: Manufacturing Site (0–9, A–Z)
NNN: Sequence number for the date listed (000–999)

12
13
14
A
B
C
D

1–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Quick Start Steps


Step 1 – Unpack and Inspect
1
a.) Unpack the C-more Micro-Graphic panel from its shipping carton. Included in the carton
are the following:
2
• C-more Micro-Graphic panel
• cutout template 3
• mounting clips (EA-MG-S3ML-BRK)
• gasket (EA-MG-S3ML-GSK)
• blank function key label insert (EA-MG-S3ML-FKL)
4
• Quick Start Guide (EA1-MG-QSG)
b.) Unpack any accessories that 5
Function Key have been ordered, such as:
Label Insert Keypad Bezel, DC Power
Adapter, programming cable,
6
Mounting
communications cable, etc.
Clips
c.) Inspect all equipment for
7
completeness. If anything is
missing or damaged, 8
immediately call the
AutomationDirect® returns
department @ 1-800-633-0405.
9
Cutout 10
Template C-more
Micro Graphic 11
Panel
12
Shipping Carton Contents
13
Optional Accessories
14
8-Button Keypad Bezel
EA-MG-BZ1
20-Button Keypad Bezel
EA-MG-BZ2
A
B
C
D

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–7
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 2 – Install Optional Hardware Accessories


Below is an example of a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel being assembled with an optional
1 EA-MG-BZ2 20-button Keypad Bezel. See the Quick Start Guide, EA1-MG-QSG, for
additional assembly instructions and illustrations.
2 3. Use (6) Bezel Mounting Clips,
EA-BZ2-BRK, to secure keypad
bezel through enclosure cutout.
3 2. Use the (2) Panel Mounting
Tighten screws to a torque of
21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm].
Clips, EA-S3ML-BRK, that
4 are supplied with the panel,
to secure panel to keypad
bezel. Tighten screws to

5 a torque of 21-28 oz-in


[0.15-0.2 Nm].

6 1. Remove
Expansion
Connector
7 Protective
Cover from
rear of
8 panel.

20 Button Keypad Bezel


9 EA-MG-BZ2
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel
10
4. Peel Protective Film
from front of panel.
11
12 NOTE: Mounting clips for the panel and keypad bezels are included with the respective product.

13
14 Optional Accessories
A
DC Power Adapter Serial Port w/ DC Power Adapter Clear Screen Overlay
EA-MG-P1 EA-MG-SP1 EA-MG-COV-CL
B
C
D

1–8 ®®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 3 – Become Familiar with Available Communication Ports


The C-more Micro-Graphic panel includes a built-in RS-232 serial communications port
designated as Port 1. This port uses an RJ12 type telephone jack to make connections to either 1
the EA-MG-PGM-CBL programming cable assembly or a communications cable, such as an
EA-2CBL, to interface with a PLC or controller. The panel can receive power through this port
from the serial communications port on select AutomationDirect PLCs. The other serial
2
communications port designated as Port 2 is available by installing the optional EA-MG-SP1
DC Power Adapter with Serial Port onto the rear of the panel, or if using an optional keypad 3
bezel, install onto the rear of the bezel with the panel installed through the front of the bezel.
Port 2 supports RS-232, RS-485 and RS-422. 4
Port 1 (built-in) Port 2 (optional) 5
C-more
Micro-Graphic
panel
RJ12 serial
communications port 1 Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter PLC 15-pin serial
6
EA-MG-SP1 communications port 2

8 1 7
15 9

8
9
Expansion Pin Signal Pin Signal Pin Signal
Pin
1
2
Signal
Logic GND
not used
Connector 1
2
Frame GND
TXD (232C)
6
7
LE
CTS (232C)
11 TXD+ (422/485)
12 TXD– (422/485)
10
3 RXD (232C) 8 RTS (232C) 13 Term. Resistor
6 5 4 3 2 1 3 RXD (232C)
4
5
TXD (232C)
+5 VDC
4
5
Future
Logic GND
9 RXD+ (422/485)
10 RXD– (422/485)
14 do not use
15 do not use 11
NOTE: Adapter requires 10.8-26.4 VDC supply.
6 Logic GND

RS-232
Adapter mounts
to back of panel
RS-232/422/485 12
NOTE: See Chapter 2: Specifications and Chapter 6: PLC Communications for additional details on the
13
available communication ports, protocols and cables.
14
NOTE: The panel has one built-in RJ12 serial communications port (Port1 - RS-232) and the option to add
one 15-pin serial communications port (Port2 - RS-232/422/485) to the panel by installing the EA-MG-SP1 A
module. Only one of the ports can be used with a connected PLC. The programming software allows the user
to select either Comm. Port1 or Comm. Port2 under the Panel Manager dialog box. When using Port 2 to
communicate with the connected PLC, Port1 can still be used with the EA-MG-PGM-CBL Software B
Programming Cable Assembly to transfer projects between the PC and panel.
C
NOTE: If the DC power adapter is installed on the panel, the adapter must be powered.
D

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–9
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 4 – Install C-more Micro-Graphic Panel


The C-more Micro-Graphic panel can be mounted through a cutout in an enclosure by using
1 the template that is provided with the panel, or using the dimensions shown below. Cutout
dimensions for the 8-button and 20-button keypad bezel options are also shown below. The
2 keypad bezels also include a template that can be used. The enclosure mounting thickness
range for the panels and the keypad bezels is 0.04”–0.2” [1–5 mm].
3 The screw torque range for the screws used on the panel mounting clips and the keypad bezel
mounting clips is 21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm].
4 See Chapter 2: Specifications for additional product dimensions.
4.016 – 0.00
+0.04

+1

5 Port 1 (built-in)
0.236 0.236
102.0 –0

0.236
[6.0] [6.0] [6.0]

6 R0
Units: inches [mm]
.11
8[

7 +0.04
2.756 – 0.00
+1
R3
] CUTOUT

CUTOUT
70.0 –0 OUTLINE

8
BEZEL
OUTLINE

9 0.236
[6.0] MOUNTING CLIP
(2) places

10 0.354
6.417 –+0.04
0.00
+1
163.0 –0
0.354
0.361
[9.2] [9.0] [9.0] EA-MG-BZ1 Keypad Bezel Cutout
11 R0
.09
8[
R2 CUTOUT
]

12 3.504 –+0.04
0.00
+1
89.0 –0
CUTOUT
OUTLINE

13 BEZEL
OUTLINE

14 0.361
[9.2]
PANEL CUTOUT
Units: inches [mm]

7.441 +0.04
– 0.00
189.0 +1
A EA-MG-BZ2 Keypad Bezel Cutout
0.361
[9.2]
0.354
[9.0]
–0
0.354
[9.0]

B R0
.09
8[
R2 CUTOUT
] CUTOUT
3.504 +0.04 OUTLINE
C NOTE: A minimum clearance of 1.2
– 0.00
89.0 +1
–0

BEZEL
inches (30mm) must be OUTLINE
D maintained around and behind the
panel to allow for proper cooling. 0.361 Units: inches [mm]
[9.2] PANEL CUTOUT

1–10 ®®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 5 – Install the Programming Software and Develop a Project


Following are the minimum system requirements for running C-more Micro-Graphic
Programming Software, EA-MG-PGMSW, on a PC: 1
• Personal Computer with a 333 MHz or higher processor (CPU) clock speed recommended;
(Windows® 2000 with Service Pack 4 or Windows® XP, 800 MHz or higher processor (CPU) 2
clock speed recommended (Windows® Vista (32 bit)); Intel® Pentium/Celeron family, or AMD®
K6/Athlon/Duron family, or compatible processor recommended
• Keyboard and Mouse or compatible pointing device
3
• Super VGA color video adapter and monitor with at least 800 x 600 pixels resolution
(1024 x 768 pixels recommended) 64K color minimum 4
• 150 MB free hard-disk space
• 128 MB free RAM (512 MB recommended); 512 MB free RAM (1GB recommended) for Vista 5
• CD-ROM or DVD drive for installing software from the CD, or internet access to download free
programming software 6
• USB pot to use with an EA-MG-PGM-CBL, USB to RS232 Programming Cable Assembly for
project transfer from the programming software to the panel 7
• Operating System - Windows® XP Home / Professional Edition Service Pack 2, Windows® 2000
with Service Pack 4, or Windows® Vista (32 bit)
Insert the supplied CD-ROM into the PC’s CD-ROM drive and follow the instructions. If you
8
need assistance during the software installation, please refer to the supplied Software Installation
Guide or call the AutomationDirect Technical Support team @ 770-844-4200. 9
Start a Project Simulate Project Send Project to panel
10
Allows you to check the operation of Download your project to the

Make a New Project


your project before downloading it to
the panel.
connected panel.
11
Select Project

Location: C:\My Documents\C-more Projects\ Browse...


Enter a name
12
Project: MyProject for your project

HMI Type: EA1-S3ML

PLC Protocol: DirectLogic K-Sequence


Select the C-more
Micro-Graphic panel 13
Select the PLC Driver
Protocol Setup...

14
A
B
C
D

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–11
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 6 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to Computer


Use an EA-MG-PGM-CBL, USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly, from an USB
1 port type A on the project development PC, through the supplied converter, to the RJ12 RS-
232 programming/PLC serial communications port on the C-more Micro-Graphic panel as
2 shown below.

3 USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly


PC to Panel Programming

4 Cable Assembly
(Includes serial & USB cables)
p/n EA-MG-PGM-CBL

5
6 User PC
Serial
Cable

7 USB
Cable

8 USB to RS232
Converter

9 C-more
Micro-Graphic

10 Panel

11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

1–12 ®®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 7 – Provide Power to the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel


• The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is powered during programming from the PC through the USB to
RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly, EA-MG-PGM-CBL. 1
• During operation, the C-more Micro-Graphic panel can be powered from most AutomationDirect
PLC’s RJ12 serial communications port by using a DV-1000CBL communications cable, or a DV-
1000CBL communications cable with a FA-15HD 15-pin HD DSub/RJ12 Adapter connected to a
2
DirectLOGIC PLC’s 15-pin HD communications port (DL06, D2-250-1 & D2-260) PLCs. See
Chapter 6: PLC Communications for additional details. 3
• The panel can also be powered by installing either the EA-MG-P1 DC Power Adapter, or the
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter to the back of the panel and supply the adapter from
a 1 Amp @ 12-24 VDC power source.
4
To PLC
RJ12 Port
Power Supplied to Panel through Cable from AutomationDirect CLICK PLC or
Direct LOGIC PLC, RS-232C (p/n DV-1000CBL)
To C-more
Micro-Graphic
Serial Port 1
5
Panel Powered from
DirectLOGIC PLC via
10 feet [3.0 m] Maximum

6
Wiring Diagram
1
6
RJ12 6-pin GND GND RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug Phone Plug
Communications Cable 1 = Sig GND
2 = +5 VDC
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
(6P6C) TXD
RXD
+5 V
4
3
2
3
4
5
RXD
TXD
+5 V
(6P6C) 1 = Sig GND
2 = not used
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
7
5 = not used GND 1 6 GND 5 = +5 VDC
6 = Sig GND 6 = Sig GND
123456 123456
8
Panel Powered from a DC Power Adapter - Wiring Diagrams
DC Power Adapter Serial Port with
DC Power Adapter
9
EA-MG-P1
EA-MG-SP1
NOTE: If either
DC power Port 2
10
adapter is
installed on the
panel, the
11
adapter must be
Recommended
DC Supply Fuse
powered. Recommended
DC Supply Fuse
12
750 mA fast acting, Supply to adapter: 750 mA fast acting, Supply to adapter:
ADC p/n AGC-75 1 A @ 12 - 24 VDC
+

(10.8 - 26.4 VDC)
+
ADC p/n AGC-75 1 A @ 12 - 24 VDC
(10.8 - 26.4 VDC) 13

GND
Equipment
Ground
Equipment
Ground
GND
14
NOTE: Recommended DC power supply to power either DC Power Adapter, AutomationDirect Part No.
PSP24-024S or PSP24-024C.
A
Maximum
To PLC
Port Connector
Cable wiring example when power is supplied to panel from either a DC
Power Adapter, EA-MG-P1, or a Serial Port w/ DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1
To C-more
Micro-Graphic
Serial Port 1
B
communication cable
length when powered
50 feet [15.0 m] Maximum
Wiring Diagram
RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug
C
(6P6C) 1 = Sig GND
GND 1 GND 2 = do not use
from an optional
DC Power Adapter
RXD
TXD
3
4
6
RXD
TXD
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
5 = +5 VDC
6 = Sig GND
D
GND GND
123456

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–13
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 8 – Accessing the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Setup Screens


The panel needs to be in the Setup Menu mode whenever a project is uploaded or downloaded.
1 To access the Setup Menu of the panel’s setup screens, press the the F1 and F5 function keys
simultaneously for three (3) seconds.
2
3
4
5
From the Setup Menu, information about the panel can be obtained, settings can be adjusted,
6 and panel functions can be tested.

7 NOTE: See Chapter 5: System Setup Screens for details on using the setup screen settings and functions.

Setup Menu

8 [pg. 5-5]

1. Information 1. Memory
[pg. 5-6] [pg. 5-6]

9 Examples 2. Protocol
[pg. 5-6]

10 3. Extensions
[pg. 5-6]

4. Versions
[pg. 5-6]

11 SETUP MENU 2. Setting


[pg. 5-7 to 5-13]
1. LCD Contrast
[pg. 5-7]
1.Information >
2.Setting >

12 3.Test Menu
4.Exit
BAK – UP DWN
>

ENT
2. Backlight
[pg. 5-8 to 5-9]

3. Beep
[pg. 5-10]

13 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 4. Calibration
[pg. 5-11]

5. Clear User Memory


14 [pg. 5-12]

6. Reset to Factory Default


[pg. 5-12]

A Total :
MEMORY
786432 Bytes
7. Hourglass
[pg. 5-13]
Usage : 26206 Bytes
3. Test Menu 1. Serial Port1 – Loop Back Test
B Free :

BAK -- --
774166 Bytes

-- --
[pg. 5-14]
Note: If a Serial Port w/ DC
Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1,
[pg. 5-14 to 5-15]

2. PLC Enquiry Test


is installed, then item 2 will [pg. 5-16]
be loop back test for Port 2

C F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
and items 2, 3 & 4 will be shown
as item 3, 4 & 5. 3. Buzzer Test
[pg. 5-16]

4. Touch Panel Test

D 4. Exit
[pg. 5-17]

Do you want to exit from System Screen?


[pg. 5-17] No[F1] / Yes[F5]

1–14 ®®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 9 – Choose C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC Protocol & Cables


PLC Drivers
Available PLC
Serial - port1 or port2 Serial - port2 only
1
Protocols Allen-Bradley DF1 Half Duplex
AutomationDirect CLICK
AutomationDirect K-sequence
Allen-Bradley DF1 Full Duplex
Allen-Bradley PLC5 DF1
2
AutomationDirect DirectNET Allen-Bradley DH485
AutomationDirect Modbus
Modicon Modbus RTU
GE SNPX (90/30, 90/70, Micro 90, VersaMax Micro)
Mitsubishi FX
3
Entivity Modbus RTU Mitsubishi Q & QnA
Omron Host Link (C200 Adapter, C500)
Omron FINS Serial (CJ1, CS1)
4
Available purchased cables Siemens PPI (S7-200 CPU)
5
Cable Description Cable Part No. Cable Description Cable Part No.
Cables for direct connect to panel’s serial port 1
(Panel powered from PLC’s serial port.)
Cables used with serial port 2 6
AutomationDirect Productivity Series,
AutomationDirect Productivity Series,
CLICK, Direct LOGIC PLC RJ-12 port,
DV-1000CBL
CLICK, Direct LOGIC PLC RJ-12 port,
DL05, DL06, DL105, DL205, D3-350, EA-2CBL 7
DL05, DL06, DL105, DL205, D3-350, D4- D4-450 & H2-WinPLC (RS-232C)
450 & H2-WinPLC (RS-232C)
Direct LOGIC (VGA Style) 15-pin port,
DL06, D2-250 (250-1), D2-260 EA-2CBL-1
8
(RS-232C).
Direct LOGIC DL405 PLC 15-pin D-sub
port, DL405
(RS-232C)
D4-1000CBL Direct LOGIC PLC RJ-11 port, D3-340
(RS-232C). EA-3CBL 9
Direct LOGIC DL405 PLC 15-pin D-sub
Direct LOGIC (VGA Style) 15-pin port,
port, DL405 (RS-232C).
Direct LOGIC PLC 25-pin D-sub port,
EA-4CBL-1
10
DL06, D2-250 (250-1), D2-260
(RS-232C) FA-15HD DL405, D3-350, DL305 DCU and all DCM’s EA-4CBL-2
Use with DV-1000CBL cable. (RS-232C).
Allen-Bradley MicroLogix 1000, 1100,
11
1200 & 1500 (RS-232C) EA-MLOGIX-CBL
Direct LOGIC PLC 15-pin D-sub port,
DL405
(RS-232C). FA-CABKIT Allen-Bradley SLC 5-03/04/05,
ControlLogix, CompactLogix, FlexLogix EA-SLC-232-CBL
12
Use with DV-1000CBL cable. DF1 port (RS-232C)
Allen-Bradley PLC-5 DF1 port
(RS-232C) EA-PLC5-232-CBL
13
Cables for direct connect to panel’s serial port 1
(Panel powered from DC Power Supply)
Allen-Bradley MicroLogix, SLC 5-01/02/03,
PLC5 DH485 port (RS-232C) EA-DH485-CBL 14
GE 90/30, 90/70, Micro 90, Versamax
Micro (Port2) 15-pin D-sub port
(RS-422A)
EA-90-30-CBL
A
Direct LOGIC PLC RJ-11 port, D3-340 MITSUBISHI FX Series 25-pin port
OP-3CBL-1 EA-MITSU-CBL
(RS-232C). (RS-422A)
MITSUBISHI FX Series 8-pin mini-DIN
B
(RS-422A) EA-MITSU-CBL-1
OMRON Host Link (C200 Adapter, C500)
(RS-232C) EA-OMRON-CBL C
NOTE: See Chapter 6: PLC Communications for a detailed chart of PLC compatibility & cable connections. D
Chapter 6 includes wiring diagrams for end user construction of certain cables.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 1–15
Chapter 1: Getting Started

Step 10 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC


Connect the serial communications cable between the C-more Micro-Graphic panel and the
PLC. The panel can be connected to the PLC via the panel’s built-in RJ12 serial
communications port (RS-232) or by using the optional EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC
Power Adapter, the panel can be connected to the PLC from the adapter’s 15-pin serial
communications port with either RS-232, RS-422 or RS-485 communications.

Example of panel’s Port 1


connected to a CLICK PLC
C-more 3 Inch
Micro-Graphic Panel

CLICK PLC
Port 1

DV-1000CBL
serial cable
Port 2

Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1

Example of panel’s optional Port 2


connected to a DL06 PLC
Port
2
Port
2
DL06 PLC

C-more to
Direct LOGIC C-more
VGA 15-pin port Micro Graphic
serial cable Panel
p/n EA-2CBL-1

1–16 ®®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
CHAPTER
SPECIFICATIONS
2
In This Chapter...
Available Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–2
Model Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–3
Panel Dimensions (all models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–5
Communications Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–6
Chemical Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2–7
Chapter 2: Specifications

Available Models
1 The C-more® Micro-Graphic panels continue the next generation of HMI panels brought to
you by AutomationDirect. They have been designed to display and interchange graphical data
2 from a PLC by merely viewing, using the function keys, or touching the screen (touch screen
model only).
The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is available in four models to suit your application. Refer to
3 the following table for part numbers, descriptions and general specifications. See Chapter 3:
Accessories for details on the available accessories for the C-more Micro-Graphic panels.
4 C-more Micro-Graphic Panels
5 Part Number Description

Touch 3.1-inch C-more Micro-Graphic Touch Panel with green and red LED backlights. Supports 5
6 Screen
selectable backlight colors (Green, Red, Amber, Yellow and Lime). STN LCD monochrome, 128
x 64 dot display. Has 5 user-defined function keys with LED indicators. Power is supplied to the
EA1-S3ML panel through the serial communication port connection when used with DirectLOGIC PLCs
having an RJ12 communication port. EA-MG-SP1 (power supply with serial option module)
7 required when connecting to third party PLCs. NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (when mounted correctly; for
indoor use only).

8 Non-
Touch
3.1-inch C-more Micro-Graphic Non-Touch Panel with green and red LED backlights. Supports
5 selectable backlight colors (Green, Red, Amber, Yellow and Lime). STN LCD monochrome, 128
x 64 dot display. Has 5 user-defined function keys with LED indicators. Power is supplied to the
9 EA1-S3ML-N panel through the serial communication port connection when used with DirectLOGIC PLCs
having an RJ12 communication port. EA-MG-SP1 (power supply with serial option module)
required when connecting to third party PLCs. NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (when mounted correctly; for
indoor use only).
10
Touch 3.1-inch C-more Micro-Graphic Touch Panel with High Contrast white and red LED backlights.
11 EA1-S3MLW*
Screen Supports 5 selectable backlight colors (White, Pink1, Pink2, Pink3 and Red). STN LCD
monochrome, 128 x 64 dot display. Has 5 user-defined function keys with LED indicators. Power
is supplied to the panel through the serial communication port connection when used with
DirectLOGIC PLCs having an RJ12 communication port. EA-MG-SP1 (power supply with serial
12 option module) required when connecting to third party PLCs. NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (when
mounted correctly; for indoor use only).

13 Non-
Touch
3.1-inch C-more Micro-Graphic Non-Touch Panel with High Contrast white and red LED
backlights. Supports 5 selectable backlight colors (White, Pink1, Pink2, Pink3 and Red). STN
LCD monochrome, 128 x 64 dot display. Has 5 user-defined function keys with LED indicators.
EA1-S3MLW-N* Power is supplied to the panel through the serial communication port connection when used with
14 DirectLOGIC PLCs having an RJ12 communication port. EA-MG-SP1 (power supply with serial
option module) required when connecting to third party PLCs. NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (when
mounted correctly; for indoor use only).
A
*NOTE: C-more Micro-Graphic panels with the letter “W” in the part number designate units with 5 selectable
B background colors of White, Pink1, Pink2, Pink3 and Red. Part numbers without the letter “W” are provided
with 5 selectable background colors of Green, Red, Amber, Yellow and Lime.

C *NOTE: Software and Firmware Version 1.5 or later is required with models EA1-S3MLW and
EA1-S3MLW-N. Available for free download at www.automationdirect.com..
D

2–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Model Specifications
The following table on the next two pages provide details to the Specifications of each available 1
C-more Micro-Graphic model.
Model 3” STN Micro-Graphic Panel 3” STN Micro-Graphic Panel 2
Specification Touch Screen non Touch Screen
Part Number: EA1-S3ML, EA1-S3MLW EA1-S3ML-N, EA1-S3MLW-N
128 x 64 dots LCD display, five user defined keypad function buttons,
3
Description: and five user defined LED's
Display: 4
• Type 3.1" STN monochrome LCD, graphical characters
• Resolution 128 (W) x 64 (H) dots 5
• Color 2 colors (normal / inverse)
• Viewing Area Size 2.789” (W) x 1.385” (H) [70.8 mm x 35.2 mm] 6
• Active Area Size 2.670” (W) x 1.259” (H) [67.8 mm x 32.0 mm]
• Contrast Adjusted from the panel’s built-in configuration setup menu
3, 9 o’clock axis –> 45 degrees
7
• Viewing Angle 6 o’clock axis –> 45 degrees

Backlight:
12 o’clock axis –> 30 degrees 8
• Type LED
5 user defined colors:EA1-S3ML, EA1-S3ML-N - Red, Green, Amber, Lime, and Yellow
9
• Color EA1-S3MLW, EA1-S3MLW-N - White, Pink1, Pink2, Pink3 and Red
• User Replaceable No 10
Touch Screen:
•Type Analog touch panel N/A 11
• Operation 51 gram force [0.5 N] maximum N/A
• Life Minimum of 1,000,000 cycles N/A 12
Features:
• User Memory 768 kBytes 13
• Number of Screens Up to 999 – limited by project memory usage
• Beep (Internal)
• Keypad Function
Yes
Five user defined function key push buttons with the ability to label.
14
Buttons Minimum of 500,000 cycles
• Keypad Function Each function key button includes a red LED that can be user programmed.
A
Button LEDs

• Serial Communications
Built-in RJ12 serial communications port (RS-232).
Optional serial communications port (RS-232, RS-485/422) when using the optional
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter.
B
Yes – used with optional Keypad Bezels, EA-MG-BZ1 & EA-MG-BZ2, and
• Expansion Connection EA-MG-P1 DC Power Adapter, and EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter. C
Specification table continued at the top of the next page. D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–3
Chapter 2: Specifications

Model Specifications (cont’d)


1 Specification
Model 3” STN Micro-Graphic Panel
Touch Screen
3” STN Micro-Graphic Panel
non Touch Screen
2 Part Number:
Screen Objects:
EA1-S3ML, EA1-S3MLW EA1-S3ML-N, EA1-S3MLW-N

Push Button, Switch, Indicator Button, Indicator Light, Graphic Indicator Light, Numeric
3 • Functional Devices
Display, Numeric Entry, Inc/Dec Value, Bar Graph, Bitmap Button, Static Bitmap, Dynamic
Bitmap, Recipe Button, Static Text, Lookup Text, Dynamic Text, Screen Change Push
Button, Screen Selector, Adjust Contrast, Function, Key Configuration Object, Line Graph,
4 • Static Shapes
Real Time Graph, Bar Meter
Lines, Rectangles, Circles and Frames
Fixed fonts: 4x6 (only in static text), 6x6, 6x8, 8x16, 8x32, 16x16, 16x32,
5 Electrical:
• Displayable Fonts 32x16, 32x32, and Windows fonts

6 • Input Voltage Range 5.0 VDC (4.75 – 5.25 VDC)


Supplied through the panel’s RJ12 serial communications port connection when used with
any Direct LOGIC PLCs having a RJ12 communication port. Can also be supplied from an
• Input Power
7 external 12-24 VDC power source when using the optional EA-MG-P1 DC Power Adapter, or
the optional EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter.
• Power Consumption 1.05 W @ 5 VDC (210 mA)
8 • Recommended Fuse Type AGC fast acting glass fuse, 250 mA, 250 VAC, ADC p/n AGC-25
No fuse required when directly connected to a PLC or PC with recommended cable.
• Max. Inrush Current 1 A for 500 µs
9 • Acceptable External Maximum 1 ms
Power Drop
10 Environmental:
• Operating Temperature 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)

11 • Storage Temperature
• Humidity
–20 to +60 °C (–4 to +140 °F)
5–95% RH, non-condensing
• Environmental Air No corrosive gases permitted
12 IEC60068-2-6 (Test Fc), 5-9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude, 9-150 Hz: 1.0G, sweeping, at a rate of
• Vibration 1 octave/min. (±10%), 10 sweep cycles per axis on each of 3 mutually perpendicular axes
13 • Shock IEC60068-2-27 (Test Ea), 15 G peak, 11 ms duration, three shocks in each direction
per axis, on 3 mutually perpendicular axes (total of 18 shocks)
EMA ICS3-304
14 • Noise Immunity RFI, (145 MHz, 440 Mhz 10 W @ 10 cm)
Impulse 1000 V @ 1 µs pulse
• Enclosure NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (When mounted correctly, for indoor use only.)
A • Agency Approvals CE (EN61131-2), UL508, CUL Canadian C22.2 No. 142-M95, UL File E157382
Physical:
B • Dimensions
• Enclosure Mounting
4.488” (W) x 3.228” (H) x 1.593” (D) [114.0 mm x 82.0 mm x 40.5 mm]
0.04” – 0.2” [1 – 5 mm]
Thickness Range
C • Mounting Clip Screw 21 – 28 oz-in [0.15 – 0.2 Nm]
Torque Range
D • Depth from bezel rear
with options Module
2.295” [58.3 mm]
• Weight 5.82 oz. (165 g)

2–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Panel Dimensions (all models)


RS232 Serial
4.488
[114.0]
1
Port 1
3.976

Panel Dimensions
[101.0]
2.835
[72.0]
MOUNTING CLIP
(2) places
2
1.357
[34.5] GASKET 3
0.236
[6.0]
1.144
[29.1]
TOP VIEW 4
Units: inches [mm] 5
RS232 Serial
Port 1
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel 6
3.228
7
[82.0]
3.409
[86.6]
2.716
[69.0] 8
9
LEFT VIEW FRONT VIEW

10
Enclosure Thickness 11
12
ENCLOSURE MOUNTING
THICKNESS RANGE

MOUNTING CLIP
(2) places
0.04" – 0.2" [1– 5 mm]

Mounting Clip Screw Torque


13
MOUNTING CLIP
SCREW TORQUE RANGE
21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm]
14
A
B
C
NOTE: A minimum clearance of 1.2 inches (30mm) must be maintained around and behind the panel to allow
for proper cooling.
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–5
Chapter 2: Specifications

Communications Ports
1 Port 1 (built-in)
2 C-more
Micro-Graphic
panel
RJ12 serial
communications port 1

3
4
5
6
Pin Signal
1 Logic GND
2 not used
6 5 4 3 2 1 3 RXD (232C)

7 4
5
6
TXD (232C)
+5 VDC
Logic GND

8
Port 2 (optional)
9
Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter
10 NOTE: If the DC
EA-MG-SP1
PLC 15-pin serial
communications port 2

power adapter 8 1

11 is installed on
the panel, the 15 9

adapter must be
12 powered and
the panel not
dependent on
13 +5 VDC from
the PLC’s RJ12 Expansion Pin Signal Pin Signal Pin Signal

14 comm port. Connector 1


2
Frame GND
TXD (232C)
6
7
LE
CTS (232C)
11 TXD+ (422/485)
12 TXD– (422/485)
3 RXD (232C) 8 RTS (232C) 13 Term. Resistor

A 4
5
Future
Logic GND
9 RXD+ (422/485)
10 RXD– (422/485)
14 do not use
15 do not use

NOTE: Adapter requires 10.8-26.4 VDC supply.


B
NOTE: The panel has one built-in RJ12 serial communications port (Port 1 - RS-232) and the option to add
C one 15-pin serial communications port (Port 2 - RS-232/422/485) to the panel by installing the EA-MG-SP1
module. Only one of the ports can be used with a connected PLC. The programming software allows the user
to select either Comm. Port1 or Comm. Port2 under the Panel Manager dialog box. When using Port 2 to
D communicate with the connected PLC, Port 1 can still be used with the EA-MG-PGM-CBL Software
Programming Cable Assembly to transfer projects between the PC and panel.

2–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility
The C-more Micro-Graphic panels are composed of three different materials that may be 1
exposed to elements outside of the enclosure. The panel’s screen in both touch and non-touch
models has a polyester (PET) surface. The bezel uses ABS plastic materials and the panel’s
gasket is a silicone rubber material. The following tables are provided to make you aware of the
2
general compatibility between chemicals that may be present in your work environment and the
various materials used in the panel. Use the table to determine those chemicals that are safe to 3
use around your C-more Micro-Graphic panel and those that may harm it. The tables are made
up of specifications provided by the manufacturer of the listed material. The tables rate these
chemicals as either Excellent, Good, Not Recommended, or Not Usable. Because the ratings are
4
for ideal conditions at room temperature, consider all factors when evaluating your application.
Areas left blank have not been tested by the manufacturer and therefore information of 5
compatibility is not available.
The values in [brackets] represent the chemical’s density at RT (room temperature), (20 °C). 6
Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %, 7
Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C]
Acetaldehyde Not Recommended 8
[10, RT] Excellent
[10, RT] Excellent 9
Acetic Acid [50, RT] Not Usable
[50-70, RT] Not Usable 10
[100, RT] Not Usable
Acetic anhydride Not Recommended 11
Acetone Excellent Not Usable
Acetophenone Not Usable 12
Acetylene Excellent
Acrylonitrile
Alcohol - Butyl Ether
Not Recommended
Excellent
13
Alcohol - Ethanol
Alcohol - Isopropyl
Excellent
Excellent
14
Alums NH3, Cr, K
Aluminum acetate
Excellent
Excellent
A
Aluminum bromide Good
Aluminum chloride Good
B
Aluminum nitrate Excellent
Aluminum sulfate Excellent
C
Ammonia [anhydrous] Good

Table continued at top of next page.


D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–7
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


1 Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
2 Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C]
Ammonia gas [cold] Good

3 Ammonia liquid Good


[12%] Not Usable
Ammonia water
4 Ammonium carbonate
[28%] Not Usable
Excellent

5 Ammonium chloride
Ammonium hydroxide
Excellent

Excellent
[ammonia water]
6 Ammonium nitrate Excellent
Ammonium persulfate Excellent
7 Ammonium phosphate Excellent
Ammonium sulfate Excellent
8 Amyl acetate Not Usable
Amyl alcohol Good

9 Aniline dyes
Animal oil [lard]
Not Recommended
Good

10 Aqua regia
Arsenic acid
Not Usable
Not Recommended

11 Asphalt
Barium chloride
Excellent
Excellent
Barium hydroxide
12 Barium sulfate
Excellent
Excellent
Barium sulfide Excellent
13 Beer Excellent
Beet sugar liquors Excellent
14 Benzaldehyde Not Recommended
Benzene [Benzol] Not Recommended
A Benzene Excellent
Benzine Not Usable Not Usable
B Benzyl alcohol Not Recommended
Benzyl benzoate Not Usable
C Benzyl chloride Not Usable
Borax Excellent
D Boric acid Good
Table continued at top of next page.

2–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone 1
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C] 2
Bromine Not Usable
Butane
Butter
Excellent
Good
3
Butyl acetate
Butyl acrylate
Not Usable
Not Usable
4
Butyl alcohol
Calcium actetate
[Butanol] Good
Excellent
5
Calcium bisulfite Good
Calcium chloride Excellent
6
Calcium hydroxide Excellent
Calcium hypochlorite [20,RT] Excellent
7
Calcium nitrate Excellent
Calcium sulfide Excellent 8
Cane sugar liquors Excellent
Carbon dioxide Excellent 9
Carbon disulfide Not Usable
Carbonic acid Good 10
Carbon tetrachloride Excellent Not Usable
Castor oil Not Recommended 11
China wood [tung] oil Excellent
Chlorine gas [dry] Not Usable 12
Chlorine gas [wet] Not Usable
Chlorine liquid Not Usable 13
Chlorinated solvents Not Usable
Chloroacetic acid Not Usable 14
Chloroacetone Not Usable
Chloroform
Chlorophenol
Excellent
Not Usable
Not Usable
A
Chlorosulfonic acid
Chlorotoluene
Not Usable
Not Usable
B
Table continued at top of next page. C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–9
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


1 Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
2 Temperature °C] Temperature °C]
[2, 70 °C] Not Usable
Temperature °C]

3 Chromic acid
[5, 70 °C] Not Usable
[10, 70 °C] Not Usable

4 Citric acid
[25, 70 °C] Not Usable
Good
Cocoanut oil
5 Copper chloride
Good
Excellent
Copper cyanide Excellent
6 Copper sulfate Excellent
Corn oil Good
7 Cottonseed oil Good
Creosol Not Usable
8 Cyclohexane Good
Cyclohexanol Good
9 Cyclohexanone Not Usable
Developing solutions [Hypos] Excellent
10 Dibutyl phthalate [DBP] Not Usable
Dichlorobenzene Not Usable
11 Diethylene glycol Good
Diethyl ether Not Usable
12 Disopropyl ketone Not Usable
Dimethyl aniline Not Usable
13 Dimethyl formamide Not Usable
Dioxane Not Usable

14 Dipentene
Epichlorohydrine
Not Usable
Not Usable

A Ethyl acetate
Ethyl acetoacetate
Excellent Not Usable
Not Usable

B Ethyl acrylate
Ethyl alcohol Excellent
Not Usable
Not Recommended
Ethyl benzene
C Ethyl chloride
Not Usable
Not Usable
Ethylene chlorohydrin Not Usable
D
Table continued at top of next page.

2–10 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone 1
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C] 2
Ethylene diamine Not Usable
Ethylene dichloride
Ethylene glycol
Not Usable
Excellent
3
Ethylene oxide
Fatty acid
Not Usable
Good
4
Ferric chloride
Ferric nitrate
Excellent
Excellent
5
Ferric sulfate Excellent
Fluorboric acid Not Recommended
6
Fluorobenzene Not Usable
Fluosilicic acid Not Recommended
7
[40, RT] Good
[25, RT] Excellent 8
Formaldehyde
[50, RT] Good
[90, RT] Not Recommended 9
Freon [45°C] Excellent
Freon 11 Not Recommended 10
Freon 12 Good
Freon 113 Not Usable 11
Freon 114 Not Recommended
Fuel oil Good 12
Gasoline Not Recommended
Gelatin Excellent 13
Glauber’s salt Excellent
Glue Excellent 14
Glycerin Excellent
Grease
Hexane
Excellent
Not Recommended
A
Hexyl alcohol Good
[20,RT] Not Usable
B
Hydrobromic acid [20-70,RT] Not Usable
[37,RT] Not Usable
C
Table continued at top of next page. D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–11
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


1 Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C]
2 [10,RT] Excellent
[15%] Excellent
3 Hydrochloric acid
[20,RT] Good
[20-80, RT] Good
[30%] Good Not Recommended
4 [38,RT] Not Recommended
Hydrocyanic acid Excellent

5 Hydrofluoric acid
[10,RT] Excellent
[20,RT] Excellent

6 Hydrofluoric acid anhydrous


[40,RT] Good
Not Usable

7 Hydrogen Excellent
[5,RT] Not Recommended
[5-50, RT]
8 Hydrogen peroxide Not Recommended
[30,RT] Not Usable

9 Hydrogen sulfide
Hydorquinone
Excellent
Not Recommended

10 Hypochlorous acid
Isobutyl alcohol
Not Recommended
Good

11 Isopropyl acetate
Isopropyl alcohol
Not Usable
Good
JP fuels (1-6) Good
12 Kerosene Good
Lacquer Not Usable
13 Lactic acid Excellent
Lard Excellent
14 Lead acetate Excellent
Lead nitrate Good
A Lead sulfamate Good
Linoleic acid Excellent
B Linseed oil Excellent
Liquified petroleum gas [LPG] Excellent
C Lubricating oil Excellent
Lye solution Excellent
D Magnesium chloride Excellent
Table continued at top of next page.

2–12 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone 1
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C] 2
Magnesium hydroxide Excellent
Magnesium sulfate
Maleic acid
Excellent
Excellent
3
Marcuric chloride
MEK Good
Excellent
4
Mercury
Metacresol Not Usable
Excellent
5
Methyl acetate Not Usable
Methyl alcohol Excellent Not Recommended
6
Methyl Benzoate Not Usable
Methyl chloride Not Usable
7
Methyl ethyl ketone [MEK] Not Usable
Methyl isobutyl ketone [MIBK] Not Usable 8
Methyl methacrylate Not Usable
Methyl dichloride Not Usable 9
Methyl Salicylate Not Usable
Milk Excellent 10
Mineral oil Excellent Excellent
Monochlorobenzene Not Usable Not Usable 11
Naptha Good
Napthalene Excellent 12
Napthenic acid Good
Natural gas Excellent 13
Natural oil Excellent
Nickel acetate Excellent 14
Nickel chloride Excellent
Nickel sulfate Excellent
[10, RT] Good
A
[30%] Good [10-70, RT] Not Usable
[30, RT] Not Usable
B
Nitric acid

[30%] Not Usable


[30-70, RT] Not Usable
[61.3, RT] Not Usable
C
[Vapor, RT] Not Usable Not Usable
D
Table continued at top of next page.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–13
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


1 Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
2 Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C]
Nitrobenzene Not Usable Not Usable

3 Nitroethane
Nitromethane
Not Usable
Not Usable

4 Nitropropane
Nitrogen
Not Usable
Excellent

5 Octyl alcohol
Oleic acid
Good
Excellent
Olive oil Excellent
6 Oxalic acid Excellent
Oxygen Excellent
7 Ozone Not Recommended
Palmitic acid Excellent
8 Perchloroethylene Not Usable
Petroleum Excellent
9 Phenol Not Usable Not Usable
[50, RT] Good
10 Phospheric acid [50-70, RT] Not Usable
[75, RT] Not Usable
11 [Sulfuric acid 20%
+ nitric acid 4%] Good
Pickling solution
12 [Sulfuric acid 40%
+ nitric acid 15%]
Not Recommended
13 Pine oil Good
Potassium chloride Excellent

14 Potassium cyanide Excellent


Potassium dichromate [10, RT] Excellent

A Potassium hydroxide
Potassium nitrate
[10%] Not Usable Excellent
Excellent

B Potassium permangante
Potassium sulfate
[5, RT] Excellent
Excellent

C Propane
Propyl acetate
Excellent
Not Usable
Propyl alcohol Good
D
Table continued at top of next page.

2–14 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone 1
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C] 2
Salt water Excellent
Silicone oils
Silver nitrate
Good
Excellent
3
Skydrol 500
Skydrol 7000
Not Usable
Not Usable Not Usable
4
Soap solutions
Soda ash
Excellent
Excellent
5
Sodium bicarbonate Excellent
Sodium bisulfate Good
6
Sodium borate Excellent
Sodium carbonate [10%] Excellent
7
Sodium chloride Excellent
Sodium cyanide Excellent 8
[10, RT] Excellent
Sodium hydroxide
[1%] Excellent
[30, RT] Excellent 9
[10%] Not Usable [30-70, RT] Not Usable

Sodium hydrochlorite
[5, RT] Excellent 10
[5-70, RT] Not Usable
Sodium metaphosphate Excellent 11
Sodium nitrate Excellent
Sodium perborate Excellent 12
Sodium peroxide Not Usable
Sodium phosphate Excellent 13
Sodium thiosulfate Excellent
Sodium sulfate [Glauber’s salt] Good 14
Sodium sulfite Excellent
Soybean oil
Stannic chloride
Excellent
Good
A
Steam [below 150 degrees]
Not Usable B
[above 150 degrees]
Steam Not Usable
Stearic acid Excellent C
Styrene Not Recommended
Sucrose solutions Excellent D
Table continued at top of next page.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 2–15
Chapter 2: Specifications

Chemical Compatibility (cont’d)


1 Screen Sheet – PET Bezel – ABS Gasket – Silicone
Chemicals [Density %, [Density %, [Density %,
2 Temperature °C] Temperature °C] Temperature °C]
Sulfur Excellent

3 Sulfur dioxide Good


[10, RT] Excellent
[20%] Excellent
4 [10-70, RT] Not Usable
[30, RT] Excellent

5 Sulfuric acid [60%] Excellent [30-70, RT]


Not Recommended
Not Usable

[98, RT] Not Usable


6 [80%] Not Usable
[Vapor, RT] Not Usable
Sulpherous acid [10, RT] Good
7 Tannic acid Good
Tar Not Recommended
8 Tartaric acid Excellent
Terpineol Not Recommended
9 Tetrachloroethane Excellent Not Usable
Tetraethyl lead Good
10 Tetralin Not Usable
Tetrahydrofuran Not Usable Not Usable
11 Thionyl chloride Not Usable
Toluene Excellent Not Usable Not Usable
12 Trichloroethylene [Trichlene] Not Usable
Triethanol amine Good
13 Turpentine oil Good
Vegetable oil Good

14 Vinegar Excellent
Water Excellent

A Whiskey
Xylene Excellent
Excellent
Not Usable

B Zeolites
Zinc acetate
Excellent
Excellent

C Zinc chloride
Zinc sulfate
Excellent
Excellent

2–16 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
CHAPTER
ACCESSORIES
3
2
In This Chapter...
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–2
C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–3
USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–6
8-Button Keypad Bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–8
20-button Keypad Bezel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–11
DC Power Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–14
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–18
Clear Screen Overlay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3–21
Chapter 3: Accessories

Accessories
1
C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software & Programming Cable
2 Part Number Description
C-more Micro-Graphic panel Windows-based configuration software.
Requires Windows 2000 with Service Pack 4 or XP Home or
3 EA-MG-PGMSW
Professional with Service Pack 2. Requires USB port connection from
PC to touch panel. Includes CD-ROM. Programming cable
(EA-MG-PGM-CBL) sold separately. Downloadable version available
4 from the Web site at no charge. Software Help Files included in
download.
6-ft. cable assembly to connect personal computer to any C-more
Micro-Graphic panel for setup and programming. (Note: This cable
5 EA-MG-PGM-CBL
assembly uses the PC's USB port and converts the signals to serial
transmissions. The USB port supplies 5 VDC to the Micro-Graphic
panel for configuration operations). Assembly includes standard USB
6 A-type connector to B-type connector cable, custom converter, and an
RS232C cable with RJ12 modular connector on each end.

7
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Accessories
8 Part Number Description
8-button keypad bezel for C-more Micro-Graphic panels, with 4 arrow
9 EA-MG-BZ1
adjust keys, and ESCAPE, MENU, CLEAR and ENTER buttons. Helps to
reduce screen wear in heavy-duty applications where operators can
use the keypad. Designed for easy drop-in of the Micro-Graphic
10 panels. No panel configuration is required.
20-button keypad bezel with numeric keypad for C-more Micro-
Graphic panels, with 4 arrow adjust keys, and ESCAPE, MENU, CLEAR
11 EA-MG-BZ2 and ENTER buttons. Helps to reduce screen wear in heavy-duty
applications where operators can use the keypad to enter numeric
data. Designed for easy drop-in of the Micro-Graphic panels. No panel
12 configuration is required.

Optional DC Power Adapter for C-more Micro-Graphic panels.


13 EA-MG-P1 Required when using third party PLCs, or when using 24 VDC power
instead of the 5 VDC supplied from the RJ12 connector of a
CLICK or Direct LOGIC PLC.
14
Optional Serial Port with DC Power Adapter for C-more Micro-Graphic
A EA-MG-SP1 panels. Serial port is a D-Sub 15-pin RS-232/RS-422/485 connector.
Required when using RS422, RS485 or third party PLCs.

B
Optional clear screen overlay used to protect C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-COV-CL displays from minor scratches and wear. Package contains 5 clear
C screen overlays.

3–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software


C-more® Micro-Graphic Programming Software is a 1
spin-off of its powerful sibling C-more Touch Panel
Programming software. It offers very high end features
designed to reduce your configuration time. Simply drag
2
and drop the objects from the object list (right side of
screen) onto the the screen construction area. Then 3
configure your PLC tags and click on the objects you wish to use. Use the built-in simulator to
review your work on your PC before ever downloading your project! 4
NOTE: Software and Firmware Version 1.5 or later is required with models EA1-S3MLW and
EA1-S3MLW-N. Available for free download at www.automationdirect.com. 5
Thumbnail project preview pane
Helps keep track of multi-screen projects. 6
Built-in user object/screen libraries
Save time by re-using your custom objects
7
and screens.
Scrolling object selection window 8
Lets you find the object you want fast. Just
drag and drop it on the screen. 9
Scrolling help window
Gives you helpful information on each object 10
Built-in project simulator
• Runs your project on your PC 11
• Test all of your screens before downloading
• Time savings pays for the panel
12
PC Requirements:
Following are the minimum system requirements for running C-more Micro-Graphic
Programming Software, EA-MG-PGMSW, on a PC:
13
• USB port for project transfer from software to touch panel
• Personal Computer with a 333 MHz or higher processor (CPU) clock speed recommended;
14
(Windows® 2000 with Service Pack 4 or Windows® XP, 800 MHz or higher processor (CPU)
clock speed recommended (Windows® Vista (32 bit)); Intel® Pentium/Celeron family, or AMD®
K6/Athlon/Duron family, or compatible processor recommended
A
• Keyboard and Mouse or compatible pointing device
• Super VGA color video adapter and monitor with at least 800 x 600 pixels resolution B
(1024 x 768 pixels recommended) 64K color minimum
• 150 MB free hard-disk space C
• 128 MB free RAM (512 MB recommended); 512 MB free RAM (1GB recommended) for Vista
• CD-ROM or DVD drive for installing software from the CD or internet access to download
• Operating System - Windows® XP Home / Professional Edition with Service Pack 2, Windows®
D
2000 with Service Pack 4, Windows® Vista, or Windows®7

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–3
Chapter 3: Accessories

Micro-Graphic Programming Software (cont’d)


1 C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Objects
Object Graphic Object Graphic
2 The Line object, just like with drawing tools, allows the user to insert a
The Numeric Display consists of a frame that displays a real-time
numeric value according to the value of data received from an assigned
straight line drawing into a project. When a Line is inserted into a
Tag Name. The Numeric Display supports numeric Signed Decimal,

3 project, a window opens to allow the user to setup all available


parameters for the Line object. Some of the uses for Line Objects
include but are not limited to adding callouts, pointers, or indicators.
Unsigned Decimal, BCD, and Floating Point data types with up to 11
digits, including decimal point. User Defined Alpha Numeric Prefix and
Suffix values are also supported.

4 The Rectangle object, just like with drawing tools, allows the user to
insert a drawing of a Rectangle as well as other geometric shapes into
The Numeric Entry object is used to enter a value from your Panel to
a PLC Register. This object, when selected, opens a Numeric Keypad
that allows the user to enter a new value that will be written to the
assigned Tag Name. The Numeric Entry supports numeric Signed
a project. When this object is inserted into a project, a window opens to
Decimal, Unsigned Decimal, BCD, and Floating Point data types with up

5 allow the user to setup all available parameters for the Rectangle object.
to 11 digits, including decimal points. User Defined Alpha Numeric Prefix
and Suffix values are also supported.

The Increment/Decrement Value object is used to add or subtract a

6 The Circle object, just like with drawing tools, allows the user to insert
a drawing of a Circle or ellipse shape into a project. When this object is
inserted into a project, a window opens to allow the user to setup all
value by pressing a button on the Panel. Basically the object uses two
Tags, one to read a value from and another to write a modified value to.
The Increment/Decrement Value supports numeric Signed Decimal,
Unsigned Decimal, BCD, and Floating Point data types with up to 11
available parameters for the Circle object.

7 digits, including decimal points. The Increment and decrement values


are also user selectable.

The Frame object allows the user to insert a Frame to the project that

8 can be used to Frame other objects. Some of the uses for Frame object
include but are not limited to graphically separating objects for different
operations that may appear on one screen and emphasizing
pushbuttons or other objects that may require more attention by the
The Real Time Graph object displays the value stored in up to two PLC
tags, over a history of up to 24 points each. One point is added at each
refresh.
operator.

9 The Pushbutton object is available from the Button Category of the


Object List window. The Pushbutton object is an electronic version of a The Line Graph object displays the values of up to 24 PLC address
typical Pushbutton normally found on control panels. The Pushbutton points. Up to two address arrays can be displayed. The line is drawn in

10 object can be used to activate or deactivate components assigned to a


Discrete Tag Name.
its entirety at each refresh.

11 The Switch object is an electronic version of a typical Switch that


normally can be found on control panels. The Switch object can be used
to activate or deactivate components assigned to a Discrete Tag Name.
The Analog Meter object is used to display the current value of a Tag
Name.

12 The Indicator Button object is available from the Button Category of


The Bar Meter object is used to monitor up to two assigned Tag Names
the Object List window. The Indicator Button object is an electronic

13 version of a typical Indicator Button normally found on control panels.


The Indicator Button is a combination of a Pushbutton and an Indicator
Light. The Indicator Button can be used to activate or deactivate
continuously. This object has various appearances depending upon the
relative value of the tags. The Bar Meter can be used to create digital
versions of level, current, and flow meters to name a few samples, or
gauges that measure speed and other measurable data.
components assigned to a Discrete Tag Name.

14 The Bitmap Button object offers the ability to use a Bitmap graphic to
perform the functions of a Button. This allows users to create their own
The Indicator Light object is an electronic version of a typical Indicator
graphics and implement them within the software project. The Bitmap

A Light normally found on industrial control panels. The Indicator Light can
be configured to display the status of the assigned Discrete Tag Name.
Button object can be used to activate or deactivate components
assigned to a Discrete Tag Name. The C-more Micro-Graphic display
only supports two colors, black and white.

The Static Bitmap offers the ability to display a Bitmap graphic on any

B The Graphic Indicator Light object is a more enhanced version of the


“Indicator Light Object” that allows the user to choose more detailed
graphics to display the status of a tag. This object is an electronic
version of a typical Indicator Light normally found on industrial control
screen. The Static Bitmap does not change state. Refer to the Dynamic
Bitmap Object if you require the graphic object to change state based
on a Tag Value in your PLC. The dialog box for a "Static Bitmap" object
allows you to "read from disk" and select a graphic file for import.
panels. The Indicator Light can be configured to display the status of the

C assigned Discrete Tag Name.


Graphics must be in one of the following formats: .BMP .WMF .JPG
.JPEG

C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Objects continued at top of next page.


D

3–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

Micro-Graphic Programming Software (cont’d)


C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Objects 1
Object Graphic Object Graphic

Recipe objects make it easy to make a large number of tag changes


The Scroll Text object is available from the Text Category of the Object
List window. The Scroll Text object is an electronic version of a marquee.
2
with the push of a single button. Create Recipes with up to 99 entries, It is similar to the Static Text Object. If the text in the object does not fit
and multiple sets of values. Then just push a button to load an entire set
of values into the group of recipe tags.
in the window, it will scroll from right to left across the window. The Scroll
Text object does not require a Tag Name assignment. The Scroll Text
Object has a maximum character limit of 128 characters.
3
The Dynamic Bitmap object offers the ability to make an object using
two different Bitmap graphics that will display one graphic when the Tag
The Screen Change Pushbutton object is available from the Control
Category of the Object List window. The Screen Change Pushbutton
object is a pushbutton that can be configured to activate another screen
4
is On and a different graphic when the Tag is Off. Use your own bitmap
in the project. This object may be edited to various colors and sizes.
designs or use some of the bitmaps provided with the software that are
located in the User Graphic Library.
Users can configure the button to activate the Power-Up screen,
Forward Screen, Previous Screen, or any one of the project screens. 5
The Static Text object is used to display a Frame with a personalized
Message. This Frame and Message can be placed on any screen and
The Screen Selector object is available from the Control Category of
the Object List window. This object is an enhanced version of the
Screen Change pushbutton in that it offers many more features and
defaults with data from screens in the project. This helps to save time by
6
any location within the screen.
not having to create Screen change buttons for each screen. This object
may be edited to various colors and sizes.
7
The Lookup Text object is used to display a Frame with a personalized The Adjust Display Contrast object is used to allow the operator to
Message. This Frame and Message can be placed on any screen and adjust the Panel Display Contrast. The default Display setting often
any location within the screen. The object is always displayed like a sign
but is configured to display only the message prompted by an assigned
Tag Name. Messages are retrieved from a Message Database which is
works in most applications, however lighting may vary based on the
location of each application. In these cases the operator can use this
object to make adjustments. The current display setting value will
8
configured by the user with text defined by the user. The Lookup Text appear on the top of the button and will change as the arrow keys are
Object will scroll text up to 128 characters.

The Dynamic Text object is used to display text that is retrieved from
data stored in a Tag. The Tag Name is assigned to registers in the PLC
pressed. This button can be modified to various sizes.

The Function object is used to assign the panels function key buttons
9
to a particular action as well as assigning the control of the LED On/Off
that contain set character data. The data can be stored in the PLC in
ASCII format and may include information such as machine numbers,
locations, part numbers, and such. The Message can be configured to
be visible (Trigger) when an associated Tag Name is On or Off. This
status. When a button has been assigned as a shift button, the then F1
through F5 will become F6 through F10. The Function Object buttons
will activate when the hardware button is pressed or when the object is
pressed on the screen. The object size is restricted so that the keys will
0
object can be placed on any screen and any location within the screen.
line up with the hardware function keys on the panel.
The Dynamic Text Object will scroll text up to 40 characters.
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–5
Chapter 3: Accessories

USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly


1 Using the C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software for project development, the C-more
Micro-Graphic panel can be connected to a PC (personal computer) by using EA-MG-PGM-
2 CBL, the USB-to-RS-232 cable assembly.
• Connect the USB programming cable ( included) from a USB port type A on the PC to the USB type
B port on the converter (included). Next connect the serial programming cable from the converter’s
3 RJ12 port to the panel’s RJ12 serial port. The panel receives power from the USB port of the PC that
it is connected to through the USB to RS-232 converter assembly.
4 EA-MG-PGM-CBL
Converter Dimensions
5
6
7
Converter Status LEDs
8 LED Status Indicators

9
10
11 TxD RxD
PWR

12 USB Connectivity
PC to Panel Programming
Cable Assembly
(Includes serial & USB cables)
p/n EA-MG-PGM-CBL

13
14 User PC
Serial
Cable

A USB
Cable

B USB to RS232
Converter
C
C-more
Micro-Graphic
D Panel

USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly continued at top of next page.

3–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

USB to RS232 Programming Cable Assembly (cont’d)


USB to RS232 Converter Specifications 1
Part Number: EA-MG-PGM-CBL
6-ft. cable assembly to connect personal computer to any C-more Micro-Graphic panel for
setup and programming. (Note: This cable assembly uses the PC's USB port and converts the
2
signals to serial transmissions. The USB port supplies 5 VDC to the Micro-Graphic panel for
Description: configuration operations.) Assembly includes standard USB A-type connector to B-type
connector cable, custom converter, and an RS232C cable with RJ12 modular connector on 3
each end.
Hardware:
USB Specification Rev. 1.1
4
• USB Interface Connector: USB Type B jack to accept USB Type B cable plug
• Serial Interface RS232 (EIA-232-E)
Connector: RJ12 phone jack 6p to accept RJ12 cable plug
5
• Baud Rate 115.2 kbps Maximum
• Input Voltage 5 VDC (Supplied thru serial interface cable.)
6
• Power Consumption 50 mA (Does not include power to panel and/or bezel.)
Accessory Cables: 7
USB Type A plug to PC on one end, USB Type B plug to converter on other end,
• USB Cable
• Serial Cable
0.30 m [1 foot] length (* Note)
RJ12 phone plug connectors on both ends, 2.0 m [6.56 feet] length (* Note)
8
Environmental:
• Operating Temperature 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)
9
• Storage Temperature -20 to 60 °C (-4 to 140 °F)
• Humidity 5 to 95 % RH (non-condensing)
10
• Environmental air No corrosive gases permitted
• Vibration IEC60068-2-6 (Test Fc), 5-9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude, 9-150 Hz: 1.0G, sweeping, at a rate of 11
1 octave/min. (±10%), 10 sweep cycles per axis on each of 3 mutually perpendicular axes
• Shock IEC60068-2-27 (Test Ea), 15 G peak, 11 ms duration, three shocks in each direction
per axis, on 3 mutually perpendicular axes (total of 18 shocks) 12
Physical:
• Dimensions 2.559” (W) x 1.417” (H) x 0.886” (D)
[65.0 mm x 36.0 mm x 22.5 mm]
13
• Weight 1.06 oz. [30 g]
* Note: Maximum cable length for either the USB or serial cable should not exceed 2.0 m [6.56 feet] in length. 14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–7
Chapter 3: Accessories

8-Button Keypad Bezel


1 The 8-button keypad bezel can be used with both the touch and non-touch 3” Micro-Graphic
panels. The keypad includes four directional arrow cursor buttons, and one each of an ESCAPE,
2 MENU, CLEAR and ENTER button. The keypad is intended to be used with the numeric
entry object (Style 3) to allow changing of a value, and can also be used to navigate & select
screen objects when using the non-touch panel version. The cursor left and right buttons are
3 used to select a digit and the cursor up and down buttons to change the value, along with the
ENTER and CLEAR buttons. It can also be used to access and navigate the screen selector
4 feature. The keypad bezel is designed for easy drop-in of a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel. No
panel configuration is required.

5
Dimensions
6 EA-MG-BZ1

7
8
9
10
11
Panel Cutout
12 6.417 –+0.04
0.00
+1
163.0 –0
0.361 0.354 0.354

13 [9.2] [9.0] [9.0]

Four directional
R0
.09 cursor buttons, and
14 3.504 –+0.04
8[
R2
] CUTOUT
CUTOUT
ESC, MENU, CLEAR
and ENTER buttons.
0.00 OUTLINE
+1
89.0 –0

A BEZEL
OUTLINE

B 0.361
[9.2]
PANEL CUTOUT
Units: inches [mm]
Panel Thickness
C NOTE: A minimum clearance of 1.2 inches
(30mm) must be maintained around and
behind the panel to allow for proper
D cooling.

8-Button Keypad Bezel continued at top of next page.

3–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

8-Button Keypad Bezel (cont’d)


8-Button Keypad Bezel Specifications 1
Part Number: EA-MG-BZ1
General: 2
• C-more Micro-Graphic EA1-S3ML, EA1-S3MLW, EA1-S3ML-N, EA1-S3MLW-N
Panels Supported
Connects with expansion connector on the rear of the C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel.
3
• Connection An expansion connector is also on the rear of the keypad bezel to allow the EA-MG-P1 DC

• Power Consumption
Power Adapter, or the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter to be attached.
None
4
• Keypad Button Life Minimum of 500,000 cycles
(2) mounting clips, EA-MG-BZ1-BRK, included.
5
• Enclosure Mounting
Note: The C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel is installed into the keypad bezel using the
mounting clips, EA-MG-S3ML-BRK, that are supplied with the panel.
6
Environmental:
• Operating Temperature 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F) 7
• Storage Temperature -20 to 60 °C (-4 to 140 °F)
• Humidity 5 to 95 % RH (non-condensing) 8
• Environmental air No corrosive gases permitted
• Vibration IEC60068-2-6 (Test Fc), 5-9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude, 9-150 Hz: 1.0G, sweeping, at a rate of
1 octave/min. (±10%), 10 sweep cycles per axis on each of 3 mutually perpendicular axes
9
IEC60068-2-27 (Test Ea), 15 G peak, 11 ms duration, three shocks in each direction
• Shock per axis, on 3 mutually perpendicular axes (total of 18 shocks)
NEMA ICS3-304
10
• Noise Immunity RFI, (145 MHz, 440 Mhz 10 W @ 10 cm)
Impulse 1000 V @ 1 µs pulse
11
• Enclosure NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (When mounted correctly, for indoor use only.)

• Agency Approvals CE (EN61131-2), UL508, CUL Canadian C22.2 No. 142-M95, UL File E157382
12
Physical:
7.126” (W) x 4.225” (H) x 2.180” (D)
13
• Dimensions [181.0 mm x 107.3 mm x 55.4 mm]
• Weight 7.05 oz. [200 g] 14
8-button Keypad Bezel
EA-MG-BZ1
A
B
C
D
8-Button Keypad Bezel continued at top of next page.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–9
Chapter 3: Accessories

8-Button Keypad Bezel (cont’d)


1
Panel and 8-Button Keypad Bezel Assembly 3. Use (2) Bezel Mounting Clips,
2 EA-BZ1-BRK, to secure keypad
bezel through enclosure cutout.
Tighten screws to a torque of
21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm].
3 2. Use the (2) Panel Mounting
Clips, EA-S3ML-BRK, that
are supplied with the panel,
4 to secure panel to keypad
bezel. Tighten screws to
a torque of 21-28 oz-in
[0.15-0.2 Nm].
5
1. Remove
6 Expansion
Connector
Protective
7 Cover from
rear of
panel.
8 Button Keypad Bezel
EA-MG-BZ1

8
9 C-more Micro-Graphic Panel

4. Peel Protective Film


10 from front of panel.

11
NOTE: Mounting clips for the panel and keypad bezels are included with the respective product.
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

3–10 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

20-button Keypad Bezel


The 20-button keypad bezel can be used with both the touch and non-touch C-more 3” Micro- 1
Graphic panels. The keypad includes four directional arrow cursor buttons, a full numeric
keypad, and one each of an ESCAPE, MENU, CLEAR and ENTER button. The keypad is
intended to be used with the numeric entry object (Style 3) to allow changing of a value, and
2
can also be used to navigate & select screen objects when using the non-touch panel version.
The numeric buttons can be used to enter a new value, or use the cursor left and right buttons 3
to select a digit and the cursor up and down buttons to change the value, along with the
ENTER and CLEAR buttons. It can also be used to access and navigate the screen selector
feature. The keypad bezel is designed for easy drop-in of a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel. No
4
panel configuration is required.
5
Dimensions
6
EA-MG-BZ2
7
6
8
9
10
11
Panel Cutout
7.441 +0.04
– 0.00
12
189.0 +1
–0
0.361
[9.2]
0.354
[9.0]
0.354
[9.0] 왗 7 8 9 Four directional
cursor buttons,
13
왘 4 5 6 numeric buttons,
R0
.09
8[
R2
]
CUTOUT
CUTOUT
왖 1 2 3 and ESC, MENU,
CLEAR and ENTER
14
3.504 +0.04
– 0.00 OUTLINE
왔 . buttons.
89.0 +1
–0

BEZEL Esc
+/ –

Menu
0
CLR Enter
A
OUTLINE

B
0.361
[9.2] PANEL CUTOUT
Units: inches [mm]
Panel Thickness
NOTE: A minimum clearance of 1.2 inches
(30mm) must be maintained around and
C
behind the panel to allow for proper
cooling. D
20-Button Keypad Bezel continued at top of next page.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–11
Chapter 3: Accessories

20-button Keypad Bezel (cont’d)


1 20-Button Keypad Bezel Specifications
Part Number: EA-MG-BZ2
2 General:
• C-more Micro-Graphic EA1-S3ML, EA1-S3MLW, EA1-S3ML-N, EA1-S3MLW-N
3 Panels Supported
Connects with expansion connector on the rear of the C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel.
• Connection An expansion connector is also on the rear of the keypad bezel to allow the EA-MG-P1 DC
4 • Power Consumption
Power Adapter, or the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter to be attached.
None

5 • Keypad Button Life Minimum of 500,000 cycles


(6) mounting clips, EA-MG-BZ2-BRK, included.
• Enclosure Mounting
6 Note: The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is installed into the keypad bezel using the mounting
clips, EA-MG-S3ML-BRK, that are supplied with the panel.
Environmental:
7 • Operating Temperature 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)
• Storage Temperature -20 to 60 °C (-4 to 140 °F)
8 • Humidity 5 to 95 % RH (non-condensing)
• Environmental air No corrosive gases permitted
9 • Vibration IEC60068-2-6 (Test Fc), 5-9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude, 9-150 Hz: 1.0G, sweeping, at a rate of
1 octave/min. (±10%), 10 sweep cycles per axis on each of 3 mutually perpendicular axes
IEC60068-2-27 (Test Ea), 15 G peak, 11 ms duration, three shocks in each direction
10 • Shock per axis, on 3 mutually perpendicular axes (total of 18 shocks)
NEMA ICS3-304
• Noise Immunity RFI, (145 MHz, 440 Mhz 10 W @ 10 cm)
11 • Enclosure
Impulse 1000 V @ 1 µs pulse
NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (When mounted correctly, for indoor use only.)

12 Physical:
• Agency Approvals CE (EN61131-2), UL508, CUL Canadian C22.2 No. 142-M95, UL File E157382

8.150” (W) x 4.225” (H) x 2.180” (D)


13 • Dimensions [207.0 mm x 107.3 mm x 55.4 mm]
• Weight 7.40 oz. [210 g]
14
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel being Installed
A in a 20-button Keypad Bezel EA-MG-BZ2

B
C
D
20-Button Keypad Bezel continued at top of next page.

3–12 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

20-button Keypad Bezel (cont’d)


1
Panel and 20-Button Keypad Bezel Assembly 3. Use (6) Bezel Mounting Clips,
EA-BZ2-BRK, to secure keypad
bezel through enclosure cutout.
2
Tighten screws to a torque of
2. Use the (2) Panel Mounting
Clips, EA-S3ML-BRK, that
21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm].
3
are supplied with the panel,
to secure panel to keypad
bezel. Tighten screws to 4
a torque of 21-28 oz-in
[0.15-0.2 Nm].
5
1. Remove
Expansion
Connector
6
Protective
Cover from
rear of
7
panel.

20 Button Keypad Bezel


8
EA-MG-BZ2
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel 9
4. Peel Protective Film
from front of panel.
10
11
NOTE: Mounting clips for the panel and keypad bezels are included with the respective product. 12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–13
Chapter 3: Accessories

DC Power Adapter
1 The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is designed to use the 5 VDC power that is available from an
RJ12 serial communications port found on most AutomationDirect CLICK and DirectLOGIC
2 PLC’s. However, for other PLC brands that do not supply power through their serial
communications port, the EA-MG-P1 DC power adapter or EA-MG-SP1 serial port with DC
power adapter should be used. Both adapters require power from a 12-24 VDC source. The EA-
3 MG-P1 DC Power Adapter for C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panels is designed to easily snap on
to the rear of a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel or the rear of an optional Keypad Bezel being
4 used with a 3” Micro-Graphic panel.

EA-MG-P1 Dimensions
5
6
7
8
Wiring Diagram
9 DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-P1

10
11
Recommended

12 +
DC Supply Fuse
750 mA fast acting,
ADC p/n AGC-75
Supply to adapter:
1 A @ 12 - 24 VDC
(10.8 - 26.4 VDC) Panel Overall Depth
with Adapter Installed
13 –
Equipment
Ground
GND

14 2.298
[58.4]
A
B Units: inches [mm]

C NOTE: A minimum clearance of 1.2 inches (30mm) must be


maintained around and behind the panel to allow for proper
cooling.
D
DC Power Adapter continued at top of next page.

3–14 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

DC Power Adapter (cont’d)


DC Power Adapter Specifications 1
Part Number: EA-MG-P1
Electrical: 2
• Input Voltage 12-24 VDC
• Input Voltage Range 10.8-26.4 VDC 3
• Power Consumption 100 mA at 24 VDC
• Maximum Power 2.90 Watts 4
• Maximum Inrush 5 A @ 500 µs with 12 VDC applied, 10 A @ 500 µs with 24 VDC applied
Current
• Recommended Fuse Type AGC fast acting glass fuse, 750 mA, 250 VAC, ADC p/n AGC-75
5
• Connector Type 3-pin screw type terminal block
Environmental:
6
• Operating Temperature 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)
• Storage Temperature -20 to 60 °C (-4 to 140 °F)
7
• Humidity 5 to 95 % RH (non-condensing)
• Environmental air No corrosive gases permitted 8
IEC60068-2-6 (Test Fc), 5-9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude, 9-150 Hz: 1.0G, sweeping, at a rate of
• Vibration

• Shock
1 octave/min. (±10%), 10 sweep cycles per axis on each of 3 mutually perpendicular axes
IEC60068-2-27 (Test Ea), 15 G peak, 11 ms duration, three shocks in each direction
9
per axis, on 3 mutually perpendicular axes (total of 18 shocks)

• Noise Immunity
NEMA ICS3-304
RFI, (145 MHz, 440 Mhz 10 W @ 10 cm)
10
Impulse 1000 V @ 1 µs pulse
• Enclosure
• Agency Approvals
NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (When mounted correctly, for indoor use only.)
CE (EN61131-2), UL508, CUL Canadian C22.2 No. 142-M95, UL File E157382
11
Physical:
3.823” (W) x 3.284” (H) x 1.331” (D)
12
• Dimensions [97.1 mm x 83.4 mm x 33.8 mm]
• Weight 2.8 oz. [80 g] 13
14
NOTE: Recommended DC power supply to power either DC Power Adapter, AutomationDirect Part No.
PSP24-024S or PSP24-024C.
A
B
NOTE: If the adapter is installed on the panel, the adapter must be powered.
C
DC Power Adapter continued at top of next page.
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–15
Chapter 3: Accessories

DC Power Adapter (cont’d)


1
DC Power Adapter
Panel to Installed
EA-MG-SP1 Assembly 2. Plug Serial Port with DC Power
2 onto a Panel Adapter, EA-MG-SP1, or DC
Power Adapter, EA-MG-P1, into
the expansion connector on the
3 3. Use (2) Panel Mounting
rear of the panel and secure
with the (3) yellow locking tabs.
Clips, EA-S3ML-BRK,
4 to secure panel through
enclosure cutout. Tighten
screws to a torque of
5 21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm].

1. Remove
6 Expansion
Connector
Protective
7 Cover from
rear of
Expansion
Connector
panel.
8
9 C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel

10 4. Peel Protective Film


from front of panel.

11
12 NOTE: Mounting clips for the panel are included with the panel.

13
14
A
B
C
D
DC Power Adapter continued at top of next page.

3–16 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

DC Power Adapter (cont’d)


1
DC Power Adapter Installed onto a
Panel with a 8-Button Keypad Bezel 2. Plug Serial Port with DC Power Adapter,
2
EA-MG-SP1, or DC Power Adapter, EA-
or a 20-Button Keypad Bezel MG-P1, into the expansion connector on
the rear of the keyboard bezel and secure 3
with the (3) yellow locking tabs.

4
5
Expansion
1. Remove
Expansion
Connector
6
Connector
Protective
Cover from
rear of
7
Bezel.
8
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel
9
and 8 Button Keypad Bezel
EA-MG-BZ1.
10
NOTE: Mounting clips for the panel and keypad bezels are included with the respective product.
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–17
Chapter 3: Accessories

Serial Port with DC Power Adapter


1 The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is designed to use the 5 VDC power that is available from an
RJ12 serial communications port of most AutomationDirect CLICK and DirectLOGIC PLC’s.
2 However, for other PLC brands that do not supply power through their serial communications
port, the EA-MG-P1 DC power adapter or EA-MG-SP1 serial port with DC power adapter
should be used. The EA-MG-SP1, with D-Sub 15-pin RS-232/RS-422/485 serial port, can be
3 used to connect to a PLC using RS-232 or RS-422/485. The adapter requires power from a 12-
24 VDC source. This optional Serial Port with DC Power Adapter for C-more 3” Micro-
4 Graphic panels is designed to easily snap on to the rear of a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel or
the rear of an optional Keypad Bezel being used with a 3” Micro-Graphic panel.
3.661
5 EA-MG-SP1 Dimensions
0.162
[93.0]
2.740
[4.1] [69.6]
6 Port 2
1.689

7 [42.9]

8 Units: inches [mm] 0.902


[22.9] TOP VIEW

9 Wiring Diagram Port 2

Serial Port with


10 DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1

Port 2 2.716 2.031


11 [69.0]
0.406
[51.6]

[10.3]
12 Recommended
DC Supply Fuse
750 mA fast acting, Supply to adapter:

13 +
ADC p/n AGC-75 1 A @ 12 - 24 VDC
(10.8 - 26.4 VDC) LEFT VIEW REAR VIEW

GND
Panel Overall Depth
14 Equipment
Ground with Adapter Installed
Port 2
A
Port 2
B 2.833
[72.0]
NOTE: A minimum clearance of

C 1.2 inches (30mm) must


be maintained around
and behind the panel to

D FRONT VIEW
allow for proper cooling.
Units: inches [mm]
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter continued at top of next page.

3–18 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

Serial Port with DC Power Adapter (cont’d)


Serial Port w/ DC Power Adapter Specifications 1
Part Number: EA-MG-SP1
Serial PLC Interface Port: 2
• Interface Standard RS232 & RS485/422
• Adjustable Settings
from Software
Baud rate: 9600, 19200 or 38400 bits/sec
Data bits: 7/8 bits
3
Parity: None, Odd/Even
(Dependent on PLC Protocol)
• Connector Type
Stop bits: 2/1 bits
15-pin D-sub connector (female)
4
Electrical:
• Input Voltage 12-24 VDC
5
• Input Voltage Range 10.8-26.4 VDC
• Power Consumption 100 mA at 24 VDC 6
• Maximum Power 2.90 Watts
• Maximum Inrush 5 A @ 500 µs with 12 VDC applied, 10 A @ 500 µs with 24 VDC applied
7
Current
• Recommended Fuse
• Connector Type
Type AGC fast acting glass fuse, 750 mA, 250 VAC, ADC p/n AGC-75
3-pin screw type terminal block
8
Environmental:
• Operating Temperature 0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)
9
• Storage Temperature
• Humidity
-20 to 60 °C (-4 to 140 °F)
5 to 95 % RH (non-condensing)
10
• Environmental air No corrosive gases permitted
• Vibration IEC60068-2-6 (Test Fc), 5-9 Hz: 3.5 mm amplitude, 9-150 Hz: 1.0G, sweeping, at a rate of
11
1 octave/min. (±10%), 10 sweep cycles per axis on each of 3 mutually perpendicular axes
• Shock IEC60068-2-27 (Test Ea), 15 G peak, 11 ms duration, three shocks in each direction
per axis, on 3 mutually perpendicular axes (total of 18 shocks) 12
NEMA ICS3-304
• Noise Immunity RFI, (145 MHz, 440 Mhz 10 W @ 10 cm)
Impulse 1000 V @ 1 µs pulse 13
• Enclosure NEMA 4/4X, IP-65 (When mounted correctly, for indoor use only.)
• Agency Approvals CE (EN61131-2), UL508, CUL Canadian C22.2 No. 142-M95, UL File E157382 14
Physical:
• Dimensions 3.823” (W) x 3.284” (H) x 1.866” (D)
[97.1 mm x 83.4 mm x 47.4 mm] A
• Weight 4.375 oz. [125 g]

NOTE: Recommended DC power supply to power either DC Power Adapter, AutomationDirect Part No.
B
PSP24-024S or PSP24-024C.
C
NOTE: If the DC power adapter is installed on the panel, the adapter must be powered.
D
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter continued at top of next page.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–19
Chapter 3: Accessories

Serial Port with DC Power Adapter (cont’d)


1 DC Power Adapter Installed onto a 2. Plug Serial Port with DC Power Adapter,
Panel with a 20-Button Keypad Bezel EA-MG-SP1, or DC Power Adapter, EA-

2 or a 8-Button Keypad Bezel


MG-P1, into the expansion connector on
the rear of the keyboard bezel and secure
with the (3) yellow locking tabs.

3
4 Expansion
Connector
5
1. Remove
Expansion
6 Connector
Protective
Cover from
7 rear of
bezel.

8
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic Panel
9 and 20 Button Keypad Bezel
EA-MG-BZ2.

10 NOTE: Mounting clips for the panel and keypad bezels are included with the respective product.

11 NOTE: When an EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter is installed, only one of the ports can be used
with a connected PLC. The programming software allows the user to select either Comm. Port1 or Comm.
12 Port2 under the Panel Manager dialog box. When using Port 2 to communicate with the connected PLC, Port
1 can still be used with the EA-MG-PGM-CBL Software Programming Cable Assembly to transfer projects
between the PC and panel.
13
Available PLC PLC Serial Serial Port w/

14 Protocols Communications Port 2


DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1
PLC 15-pin serial
communications port 2

8 1

A Serial - port1 or port2


AutomationDirect CLICK
PLC Drivers
Serial - port2 only*
Allen-Bradley DF1 Half Duplex
15 9

AutomationDirect K-sequence Allen-Bradley DF1 Full Duplex


B AutomationDirect DirectNET
AutomationDirect Modbus
Allen-Bradley PLC5 DF1
Allen-Bradley DH485
Modicon Modbus RTU GE SNPX (90/30, 90/70, Micro 90, VersaMax Micro)

C Entivity Modbus RTU Mitsubishi FX


Mitsubishi Q & QnA
Omron Host Link (C200 Adapter, C500)
Expansion
Connector
Pin
1
Signal
Frame GND
Pin
6 LE
Signal Pin
11
Signal
TXD+ (422/485)
2 TXD (232C) 7 CTS (232C) 12 TXD– (422/485)
Omron FINS Serial (CJ1, CS1)

D Siemens PPI (S7-200 CPU)


*Note: Serial port2 requires the use of EA-MG-SP1 adapter
3
4
5
RXD (232C)
Future
Logic GND
8
9
RTS (232C)
RXD+ (422/485)
10 RXD– (422/485)
13 Term. Resistor
14 do not use
15 do not use
See the PLC Compatibility & Connection Charts in Chapter 6 for details NOTE: Adapter requires 10.8-26.4 VDC supply.

3–20 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 3: Accessories

Clear Screen Overlay


Optional clear screen overlay used to protect C-more Micro-Graphic displays from minor 1
scratches and wear. Package contains 5 clear screen overlays.

EA-MG-COV-CL Dimensions 2
3
4
5
6
Clear Screen Overlay Installation 7
Step 1 Step 2
8
9
10
Remove the overlay from the
package 11
Remove the paper backing 12
from the overlay

Step 4 13
Step 3
14
A
Align the overlay with the screen
B
and press the adhesive firmly C
into place Remove the protective film*
*NOTE: The overlay cover ships with a thin protective film on the face that should be carefully removed D
after installation.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 3–21
CHAPTER
INSTALLATION & WIRING
4
In This Chapter...
Safety Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–3
Panel Cutout Dimensions (all models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–4
Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4–5
Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring

Safety Guidelines
1
NOTE: Products with CE marks perform their required functions safely and adhere to relevant standards as
2 specified by CE directives provided they are used according to their intended purpose and that the
instructions in this manual are adhered to. The protection provided by the equipment may be impaired if this
equipment is used in a manner not specified in this manual. A listing of our international affiliates is available
3 on our Web site: http://www.automationdirect.com

WARNING: Providing a safe operating environment for personnel and equipment is your responsibility and
4 should be your primary goal during system planning and installation. Automation systems can fail and
may result in situations that can cause serious injury to personnel or damage to equipment. Do not rely
5 on the automation system alone to provide a safe operating environment. You should use external
electromechanical devices, such as relays or limit switches, that are independent of the PLC application
to provide protection for any part of the system that may cause personal injury or damage. Every
6 automation application is different, so there may be special requirements for your particular application.
Make sure you follow all national, state, and local government requirements for the proper installation
and use of your equipment.
7
Plan for Safety
8 The best way to provide a safe operating environment is to make personnel and equipment safety
part of the planning process. You should examine every aspect of the system to determine which areas
9 are critical to operator or machine safety. If you are not familiar with control system installation
practices, or your company does not have established installation guidelines, you should obtain
10 additional information from the following sources.
• NEMA — The National Electrical Manufacturers Association, located in Washington, D.C. publishes
many different documents that discuss standards for industrial control systems. You can order these
11 publications directly from NEMA. Some of these include:
ICS 1, General Standards for Industrial Control and Systems
12 ICS 3, Industrial Systems
ICS 6, Enclosures for Industrial Control Systems
13 • NEC — The National Electrical Code provides regulations concerning the installation and use of
various types of electrical equipment. Copies of the NEC Handbook can often be obtained from your
14 local electrical equipment distributor or your local library.
• Local and State Agencies — many local governments and state governments have additional
requirements above and beyond those described in the NEC Handbook. Check with your local
A Electrical Inspector or Fire Marshall office for information.

B
C
D

4–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring

Introduction
The installation and wiring of C-more® Micro-Graphic panels require selecting an appropriate 1
location for the panel, laying out the cutout dimensions on the surface of the control cabinet
that the panel will be mounted through, securing the panel with the provided mounting clips,
tightening the screws to the appropriate torque rating to assure the gasket is sealing correctly,
2
and finally connecting the appropriate power source to the panel.
Note: Each C-more Micro-Graphic panel is provided with a cutout template to make marking the proper
3
cutout size on the surface of the control cabinet that the panel will be mounted through a simple task.The
keypad bezels are also provided with an appropriate cutout template for mounting convenience. 4
The C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panels include two mounting clips. The clip is a long metal
bracket with two screws. It is fitted to the panel by inserting two tabs into mating slots on the 5
panel and then sliding the clip into a narrower slot to secure it in place.
If using the panel with either the 8-button or 20-button Keypad Bezel, then install the panel 6
into the keypad bezel and secure with the mounting clips that are provided with the panel.
Create a cutout in the enclosure that the assembled panel and keypad bezel will be mounted
through and secure the assembly with the mounting clips that are provided with the keypad
7
bezel. See Chapter 3: Accessories for additional details.
This chapter only covers the proper mounting of the panel and connecting power. Once power
8
is applied to the panel, read Chapter 5, System Setup Screens, to check the information menu
to make sure the panel has the latest version of firmware, become familiar with the panel test 9
features, and check the memory usage.
The next step will be to select the appropriate PLC protocol and communications cable as 10
described in Chapter 6.
11
12
8-Button Keypad Bezel
Panel Mounting Clips Mounting Clips 20-Button Keypad Bezel 13
EA-MG-S3ML-BRK EA-MG-BZ1-BRK Mounting Clips
EA-MG-BZ2-BRK 14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 4–3
Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring

Panel Cutout Dimensions (all models)


1 The C-more 3” panel is mounted into a cutout through the control cabinet and secured with
two (2) mounting clips. The mounting clips are provided with the panel. There is a set of two
2 (2) “T” shaped holes (slots) on each side of the panel’s long dimension that the two tabs on each
mounting clip will match. The mounting clips are held in place by inserting the tabs into the
“T” shaped holes (slots) and then moving the mounting clip toward the rear of the panel to keep
3 it in place. Next tighten the mounting clip screws to pull the rear of the panel’s bezel to the
control cabinet’s mounting surface. The screws need to be tightened to the torque rating shown
4 in the illustration below so that the gasket is compressed to form the proper seal between the
panel and cabinet surface.

5 +0.04
4.016 – 0.00
+1
102.0 –0
6 0.236 0.236 0.236
[6.0] [6.0] [6.0]
7
Units: inches [mm]

8 R0
.11
8[
R3 CUTOUT
]
+0.04
9 2.756 – 0.00
+1
70.0 –0
CUTOUT
OUTLINE

10
BEZEL
11 0.236
OUTLINE

[6.0] MOUNTING CLIP


12 (2) places

13 Enclosure Mounting Thickness Ranges


and Mounting Bracket Screw Torque
14
MOUNTING CLIP
SCREW TORQUE RANGE
A 21-28 oz-in [0.15-0.2 Nm]

ENCLOSURE MOUNTING
THICKNESS RANGE
B MOUNTING CLIP
(2) places
0.04" – 0.2" [1– 5 mm]

C
NOTE: A minimum clearance of 1.2 inches (30mm) must
D be maintained around and behind the panel to allow
for proper cooling.

4–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring

Wiring Guidelines
WARNING: To minimize the risk of potential safety problems, you should follow all applicable local and
1
national codes that regulate the installation and operation of your equipment. These codes vary from
area to area and it is your responsibility to determine which codes should be followed, and to verify 2
that the equipment, installation, and operation are in compliance with the latest revision of these
codes.
Equipment damage or serious injury to personnel can result from the failure to follow all applicable 3
codes and standards. We do not guarantee the products described in this publication are suitable for
your particular application, nor do we assume any responsibility for your product design, installation,
or operation.
4
If you have any questions concerning the installation or operation of this equipment, or if you need
additional information, please call us at 1-800-633-0405 or 770-844-4200. 5
This publication is based on information that was available at the time it was printed. At
Automationdirect.com® we constantly strive to improve our products and services, so we reserve the
right to make changes to the products and/or publications at any time without notice and without
6
obligation. This publication may also discuss features that may not be available in certain revisions of
the product. 7
Providing Power to the Micro-Graphic Panel 8
• The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is powered during programming from the PC through the USB to
RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly, EA-MG-PGM-CBL.
• During operation, the C-more Micro-Graphic panel can be powered from most AutomationDirect 9
CLICK or DirectLOGIC PLC’s RJ12 serial communications port by using a DV-1000CBL
communications cable, or a DV-1000CBL communications cable with a FA-15HD 15-pin HD
DSub/RJ12 Adapter connected to a DirectLOGIC PLC’s 15-pin HD communications port (DL06,
10
D2-250-1 & D2-260) PLCs. See Chapter 6: PLC Communications for additional details.
• The 3” panel can also be powered by installing either the EA-MG-P1 DC Power Adapter, or the 11
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter to the back of the panel and supply the adapter from
a 1 Amp @ 12-24 VDC power source.
12
Panel Powered from CLICK or Direct LOGIC PLC via Communications Cable
To PLC
RJ12 Port
Power Supplied to Panel through Cable from AutomationDirect CLICK PLC or
Direct LOGIC PLC, RS-232C (p/n DV-1000CBL)
To C-more
Micro-Graphic
Serial Port 1
13
10 feet [3.0 m] Maximum 14
Wiring Diagram

1 = Sig GND
RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug
(6P6C)
GND
TXD
6
4
1
3
GND
RXD
RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug
(6P6C) 1 = Sig GND
A
2 = +5 VDC 3 4 2 = not used
RXD TXD
3 = RXD 3 = RXD
4 = TXD
5 = not used
6 = Sig GND
+5 V
GND
2
1
5
6
+5 V
GND
4 = TXD
5 = +5 VDC
6 = Sig GND
B
123456 123456

C
NOTE: Maximum cable length when the panel is powered via a CLICK or DirectLOGIC PLC is 10 feet.
D
Wiring Guidelines continued at top of the next page.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 4–5
Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring

Wiring Guidelines (cont’d)


1 Panel Powered from a DC Power Adapter – Wiring Diagrams
2 DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-P1
Serial Port with
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1
3 Port 2

4
5 Recommended
DC Supply Fuse Recommended
DC Supply Fuse
750 mA fast acting, Supply to adapter:
750 mA fast acting, Supply to adapter:
6 +
ADC p/n AGC-75 1 A @ 12 - 24 VDC
(10.8 - 26.4 VDC)
+
ADC p/n AGC-75 1 A @ 12 - 24 VDC
(10.8 - 26.4 VDC)
– –
7 Equipment
Ground
GND
Equipment
GND

Ground

8 Tightening Torque
Power supply wire connection 1.7 lb-in (0.2 Nm)
Required Wire Specification
Supported temperature Over 60 °C

9 Wire Material
Wire Size
Copper
16 - 22 AWG

10 NOTE: Recommended DC power supply to power either DC Power Adapter, AutomationDirect Part No.
PSP24-024S or PSP24-024C.
11
12 NOTE: If either the EA-MG-P1 DC Power Adapter or the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter is
installed on the 3” Micro-Graphic panel, then the adapter must be powered. The error message below will be
displayed on the panel if power is not applied. The RJ12 serial communications port (Port 1) on the panel
13 can still be used to communicate with a PLC or control device while using one of the adapters, but the
+5 VDC power through the serial cable from AutomationDirect PLC’s RJ12 serial comm port is not used.

14
A R100:
Option module
detected without
external power

B
C F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

Wiring Guidelines continued at top of the next page.


D

4–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring

Wiring Guidelines (cont’d)


Maximum communication cable length when powered from optional DC Power Adapter
1
is 50 ft. (15 m) 2
To PLC Cable wiring example when power is supplied to panel from either a DC To C-more
Port Connector Micro-Graphic
Power Adapter, EA-MG-P1, or a Serial Port w/ DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port 1
3
50 feet [15.0 m] Maximum
Wiring Diagram
1
RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug
(6P6C) 1 = Sig GND
4
GND GND 2 = do not use
RXD
TXD
3
4
6
RXD
TXD
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
5 = +5 VDC
6 = Sig GND
5
GND GND
123456

6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 4–7
CHAPTER
SYSTEM SETUP SCREENS
5
In This Chapter...
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–2
Accessing the System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–3
System Setup Screens Flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–4
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–5
Information Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Extensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Versions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–6
Setting Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–7
LCD Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–7
Backlight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–8
Beep . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–10
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–11
Clear User Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–12
Reset to Factory Default . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–12
Hourglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
Test Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–14
Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–14
Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–15
PLC Enquiry Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–16
Buzzer Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–16
Touch Panel Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–17
Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5–17
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Introduction
1 The C-more® Micro-Graphic panels include a series of built-in System Setup Screens that
allow the user to view detailed information about the panel, adjust features, test various
2 functions of the panel, clear memory, and reset all values and conditions back to the original
factory defaults.
The following is presented to give the user a detailed step by step look at:
3 • How to access the System Setup Screens
• What adjustments and features are available
4 • When and why the feature may need to be adjusted or used
• How to adjust and/or interrupt the features
5 The System Setup Screens from the Setup Menu are split into three different categories to make
it simple for the user to select the area for viewing information, making adjustments, or testing
the panel. The three Setup Menu selections are:
6 Information
7 Here you will find detailed information in regards to the panel’s available memory and usage,
the protocol being used by the panel, if any optional extension, such as a keypad bezel and/or
DC power adapter is installed on the panel, and version information for the firmware and boot
8 loader.
Setting
9 This is the area for adjusting the contrast of the display, selecting one of the five backlight colors
enabling or disabling the internal audible beeper, calibrating the touch panel, clearing the user
10 memory, resetting all of the settings back to the factory defaults, and setting the loading screen
hourglass icon delay time or disabling the display of the hourglass icon. The factory defaults are
a contrast value of 3, a green backlight, the internal audible beeper enabled, forced touch panel
11 calibration on the touch panel version, user program cleared from memory, and hourglass icon
delay of 350 ms.
12 Test Menu
The test menu includes the ability to test the built-in serial port (Port 1 – RS-232) of the panel
13 using a loop back connector, do an enquiry to determine if a PLC is connected, perform a test
of the internal audible beeper and test the response of the touch screen surface on touch screen
14 models. Refer to page 14 and 15 of this chapter for details on loop back connector wiring. If the
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter (Port 2 – RS-232/485/422) is installed, the
adapter will be detected and the ability to test this additional port using loop back connectors
A for RS-232 and RS-485/422 will be shown on the test menu.

B
C
D

5–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Accessing the System Setup Screens


To access the Setup Menu of the panel System Setup Screens, press the panel’s BAK [F1] and 1
ENT [F5] function keys simultaneously for three (3) seconds as shown below. The System
Setup Screens’ Setup Menu will be displayed as shown at the bottom of this page.
2
Press both the F1 and F5 function
keys simultaneously for 3
3
seconds to bring up the System
C-more
Setup Screens’ Setup Menu. Micro-Graphic 4
Panel
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
SETUP MENU 13
1.Information >
2.Setting
3.Test Menu
>
> 14
4.Exit
BAK – UP DWN ENT
A
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–3
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

System Setup Screens Flowchart


1
Setup Menu
2 [pg. 5-5]

3 1. Information
[pg. 5-6]
1. Memory
[pg. 5-6]

4 2. Protocol
[pg. 5-6]

5 3. Extensions
[pg. 5-6]

6 4. Versions
[pg. 5-6]

7 2. Setting
[pg. 5-7 to 5-13]
1. LCD Contrast
[pg. 5-7]

8 2. Backlight
[pg. 5-8 to 5-9]

9 3. Beep
[pg. 5-10]

10 4. Calibration
[pg. 5-11]

11 5. Clear User Memory


[pg. 5-12]

12 6. Reset to Factory Default


[pg. 5-12]

13 7. Hourglass
[pg. 5-13]

14 3. Test Menu
[pg. 5-14]
1. Serial Port1 – Loop Back Test
[pg. 5-14 to 5-15]
Note: If a Serial Port w/ DC
Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1, 2. PLC Enquiry Test
A is installed, then item 2 will
be loop back test for Port 2
and items 2, 3 & 4 will be shown
[pg. 5-16]

as item 3, 4 & 5. 3. Buzzer Test


B [pg. 5-16]

4. Touch Panel Test


C [pg. 5-17]

4. Exit Do you want to exit from System Screen?


D [pg. 5-17] No[F1] / Yes[F5]

5–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setup Menu
To navigate the different selections under the Setup Menu, 1
SETUP MENU use the function keys. BAK [F1] to return to the project
1.Information
2.Setting
>
>
screen or previous screen, UP [F3] to cursor up, DWN [F4]
to cursor down, and ENT [F5] to enter a selection.
2
3.Test Menu >
4.Exit
BAK – UP DWN ENT Pressing ENT [F5] with Information highlighted will take
3
you to the Information menu screen. See page 5-6.
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
4
5
SETUP MENU 6
1.Information >
2. Setting
3.Test Menu
>
>
Pressing ENT [F5] with Setting highlighted will take you to
the Setting menu screen. See page 5-7.
7
4.Exit
BAK – UP DWN ENT
8
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
9
10
SETUP MENU
1.Information > Pressing ENT [F5] with Test Menu highlighted will take you 11
2. Setting >
to the Test Menu screen. See page 5-12.
3.Test Menu
4.Exit
>
12
BAK – UP DWN ENT

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
13
14
SETUP MENU A
1.Information >
2. Setting
3.Test Menu
>
>
Pressing ENT [F5] with Exit highlighted will allow the used
to decided whether to Exit or not Exit the System Setup
B
4.Exit Screens. See page 5-15.
BAK – UP DWN ENT C
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–5
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Information Menu
1 Pressing ENT [F5]
INFORMATION
with Memory MEMORY
2 1.Memory >
highlighted will
show the total Total :
Usage :
786432 Bytes
26206 Bytes
2.Protocol >
memory available,
3 3.Extensions
4.Versions
>
> memory usage and
Free : 774166 Bytes

BAK -- UP DWN ENT free memory BAK -- -- -- --

4 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
available for the
project. F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

5 Pressing ENT [F5]


with the Protocol
6 INFORMATION highlighted will PROTOCOL
1.Memory > show the PLC Protocol Type :
7 2.Protocol
3.Extensions
>
>
Protocol that has
been assigned to the
DirectLogic K-Sequence
Version : 0.6.3
4.Versions >
panel and the
8 BAK -- UP DWN ENT
protocol version.
BAK -- -- -- --

9 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

10 Pressing ENT [F5]


with the Extensions
INFORMATION highlighted will list EXTENSIONS
11 1.Memory > the optional keypad Detected Devices :
2.Protocol > bezel and/or DC P1
BZ1
12 3.Extensions
4.Versions
>
>
power adapter that
are installed on the BAK -- -- -- --
BAK -- UP DWN ENT
panel. The example
13 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
here shows the EA- F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
MG-P1 & EA-MG-
14 BZ1.

A INFORMATION
Pressing ENT [F5]
with the Versions
VERSIONS

1.Memory > Firmware : 0.9.31


highlighted will show
B 2.Protocol
3.Extensions
>
> the panel’s firmware
Boot Loader : V1.00

4.Versions > and boot loader


C BAK -- UP DWN ENT versions. BAK -- -- -- --

D F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

5–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting Menu
Use the UP [F3] and DWN [F4] function keys to scroll 1
SETTING through the list of settings. There are five selections on the
1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
>
>
first screen and additional selections on a second screen. You
can also use the NXT [F2] function key to go back and forth
2
3.Beep >
4.Calibration between the two screens without having to use the up and
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
down keys. The BAK [F1] function key will return you to 3
the previous screen. Use the ENT [F5] function key to make

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
your selection once you have the setting highlighted. 4
The Setting screen includes the following:
LCD Contrast - page 5-7 5
Backlight – page 5-8
SETTING Beep – page 5-9 6
6.Reset to Factory Defa Calibration – page 5-10
7.Hourglass
Clear User Memory – page5-11 7
Reset to Factory Default – page 5-11
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
Hourglass – page 5-13 8
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
9
Setting – LCD Contrast 10
With LCD Contrast
SETTING
highlighted, press 11
ENT [F5] to bring LCD CONTRAST
1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
3.Beep
>
>
>
up the screen
showing the current
Current Value: 3
12
4.Calibration
value. The default is
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT a value of 3. The BAK -- UP DWN APL
13
contrast can be
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
adjusted between 1
to 5, with 1 being
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 14
the least amount of
contrast and 5 being A
the highest amount.
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–7
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting – Backlight, Models EA1-S3ML & EA1-S3ML-N


1 With Backlight
SETTING highlighted, press BACKLIGHT
2 1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
2
yellow
ENT [F5] to bring
up the screen Current Value: green
3.Beep on
4.Calibration showing the current
3 5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
backlight screen
color. The default is BAK -- UP DWN APL

4 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
green. The UP [F3]
and DWN [F4] F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
function keys can be
5 used to scroll
through the five
6 BACKLIGHT
available backlight
colors (green, lime,
BACKLIGHT
Current Value: lime Current Value: yellow
yellow, amber and
7 red). Use the APL
[F5] function key to
8 BAK -- UP DWN APL apply the new color.
Shown here are the
BAK -- UP DWN APL

various backlight
9 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
colors.
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

10
BACKLIGHT BACKLIGHT
11 Current Value: amber Current Value: red

12 BAK -- UP DWN APL BAK -- UP DWN APL

13 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

14
Note: Loading a project to the panel will override whatever color is choosen from the System Setup Screens’
A Backlight color selection screen. The selected color is displayed only when in the System Setup Screens.

B
C
D

5–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting – Backlight, Models EA1-S3MLW & EA1-S3MLW-N


With Backlight 1
SETTING highlighted, press BACKLIGHT
1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
2
white
ENT [F5] to bring
up the screen Current Value: white 2
3.Beep on
4.Calibration showing the current
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
backlight screen 3
color. The default is BAK -- UP DWN APL

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
white. The UP [F3]
and DWN [F4] F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
4
function keys can be
used to scroll 5
through the five
BACKLIGHT
available backlight
colors (white, pink1,
BACKLIGHT 6
Current Value: pink1 Current Value: pink2
pink2, pink3 and
red). Use the APL 7
[F5] function key to
BAK -- UP DWN APL apply the new color.
Shown here are the
BAK -- UP DWN APL
8
various backlight
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
colors.
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
9
10
BACKLIGHT BACKLIGHT
Current Value: pink3 Current Value: red 11
BAK -- UP DWN APL BAK -- UP DWN APL
12
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
13
14
Note: Loading a project to the panel will override whatever color is choosen from the System Setup Screens’
Backlight color selection screen. The selected color is displayed only when in the System Setup Screens. A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–9
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting – Beep
1 With Beep
SETTING highlighted, press BEEP
2 1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
>
>
ENT [F5] to show
the current value for Current Value: on
3.Beep >
the internal beeper.
3 4.Calibration
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
The default is ON.
The UP [F3] and BAK -- UP DWN APL

4 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
DWN [F4] function
keys can be used to F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
toggle between the
5 ON and OFF state
for the beeper
6 (enable or disable).
Use the APL [F5]
function key to
7 apply the selection.

8
9
10 Note: Loading a project to the panel will override whatever selection is choosen for the beeper from the
System Setup Screens’ Beep on/off selection screen. The Beep on/off choice can be changed through the
System Setup Screens after a project is loaded.
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

5–10 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting – Calibration
With Calibration 1
SETTING highlighted, press Press Cross Mark

1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
>
>
ENT [F5] to bring
up the first Panel will not
2
3.Beep > Communicate
calibration screen as
4.Calibration
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
shown on the right.
in this mode.
3
Touch the “cross” in Press F1 to quit

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
the upper left corner
as accurately as you F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
4
can. When the
screen is touched, 5
the cross will move
to the lower right
corner and finally to
Press Cross Mark 6
the center of the Panel will not
screen. If the touch Communicate
in this mode.
7
points are within
the built-in
calibration
Press F1 to quit 8
tolerance, the final
screen will allow
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
9
you to either save
and quit from the
calibration
10
Press Cross Mark
procedure, or allow
you to retry. If the 11
points that were
touched are not 12
within the Press F1 to quit
calibration
tolerance, you will F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
13
be returned to the
first calibration 14
screen and will need
to start over. A
F5 to Save & Quit
F1 to Retry
B
C
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–11
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting – Clear User Memory


1 With Clear User
SETTING Memory SETTING
2 1.LCD Contrast
2.Backlight
>
>
highlighted, press
ENT [F5]. You will
1.
2.
Are you sure you
want to clear
memory?
3.Beep > 3.
be given the choice
3 4.Calibration
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN
to either proceed
ENT
4.
5.
No[F1] / Yes[F5]

with clearing the BAK NXT UP DWN ENT

4 F1 F2 F3 F4
user memory by
pressing [F5] for
F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
YES or allowed to
5 cancel by pressing
[F1] for NO.
6
7
8
Setting – Reset to Factory Default
9 With Reset to
Factory Default
10 SETTING
6.Reset to Factory Defa
highlighted, press
ENT [F5]. Press 6. Reset
Are
SETTING
to Factory Default you
you sure
7.Hourglass want to clear
7.
[F5] to restore all memory?
11 settings to factory No[F1] / Yes[F5]
BAK NXT UP DWN defaults and clear
ENT BAK NXT UP DWN ENT

12 user memory. Press


{F1] to cancel.
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

13
14 The Factory Default values are:
• LCD Contrast value of 3
A • Green backlight color for EA1-S3ML & EA1-S3ML-N
• White backlight color for EA1-S6MLW & EA1-S3MLW-N
• The internal audible beeper enabled
B • Forced touch panel calibration on the touch panel version
• User program cleared from memory
• Hourglass icon delay of 350 ms.
C NOTE: User memory is cleared when factory defaults are reset. Use the C-more Micro programming
software to read the project from the panel and save a backup copy.
D

5–12 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Setting – Hourglass
The Hourglass 1
SETTING selection listed under HOURGLASS
6.Reset to Factory Defa
7.Hourglass
the Setting menu can
be used to either
Delay/Disable ICON:
350ms
2
disable the display of
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT
the hourglass icon or
BAK -- UP DWN APL
3
set the amount of

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
delay time (0 ms to
1000 ms) desired F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
4
before it is displayed.
With Hourglass
5
highlighted, press
ENT [F5]. The UP
HOURGLASS
6
[F3] and DWN [F4]
Delay/Disable ICON:
function keys are
used to scroll
Disable 7
through the
selections. Use the BAK -- UP DWN APL 8
APL [F5] function
key to apply the
selection.
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 9
Explanation: An
hourglass icon is
10
displayed on the
panel anytime a new
Hourglass Icon
11
screen is being
loaded until
communication is
12
established with the
new screen. If 13
communication is
established before the
set delay time has
14
timed out, no
hourglass will be F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
A
displayed. The
hourglass icon can
also be disabled from
B
being displayed.
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–13
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Test Menu
1 Use the UP [F3] and DWN [F4] function keys to scroll
TEST MENUthrough the list of tests. There are normally three selections
2 on the Test Menu screen. If the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
2.PLC Enquiry Test
DC Power Adapter is installed, then Serial Port 2 becomes
3.Buzzer Test available to the panel, and this serial port can also be tested by
3 4.Touch Panel Test
BAK -- UP
the use of loop back connectors. The BAK [F1] function key
DWN ENT
will return you to the previous screen. Use the ENT [F5]
4 F1 F2 F3
function key to make your selection once you have the test
highlighted.
F4 F5

5 The Test Menu screen includes the following:


Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test – page 5-13
6 Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test – page 5-14
PLC Enquiry Test – page 5-15
7 Buzzer Test – page 5-15
Touch Panel Test – page 5-17
8 Test Menu – Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
9 With Serial Port1 -
Loop Back Test
TEST MENU LOOP BACK TEST
highlighted, press
10 1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
2.PLC
Use Loop-Back ENT [F5] to bring
Enquiry Test and
Serial Port1:
Bytes Sent 153
Connector Receive Counts 153
3.Buzzer
PressTest ENT up the screen shown
11 4.Touch Panel Test
BAK -- UP
to the left. Connect
a loop back
DWN ENT
Error Counts

BAK -- -- --
0

--

connector
12 F1 F2 F3 constructed as
F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
shown here and
13 press ENT [F5] to
start the test. If the
RJ12 Loop-back Connector
14 RJ12 6-pin
test is passing, the
Receive Counts will LOOP BACK TEST
Phone Plug Jumper equal the Bytes Serial Port1:
A (6P6C) Pin 3 to 4
Sent. If the serial Bytes Sent
Receive Counts
12
0
port is not working, Error Counts 12

B 3 then the Error


RXD
Counts will equal
BAK -- -- -- --

4
the Bytes Sent. The
TXD
C 123456
test will continue F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

Wiring Diagram until the BAK [F1]


D key is pressed.

5–14 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Test Menu – Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test


If the EA-MG-SP1 1
Serial Port with DC
TEST MENU
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
Power Adapter
module is installed
TEST MENU
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
2
Use Loop-Back
2.Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test on the panel, then 2.Serial Port2 - Loop and
Connector Back Test
3.PLC Enquiry Test
4.Buzzer Test
the screen to the left 3.PLC EnquiryENT
Press
4.Buzzer Test
Test 3
BAK -- UP DWN ENT will be displayed BAK -- UP DWN ENT
when the Test Menu
is brought up. With
4
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
Serial Port2 - Loop
Back Test selection 5
highlighted, press
RS-232 Loop-back Connector
ENT [F5] to bring
up the screen shown LOOP BACK TEST
6
to the right. At this Serial Port2:
15-pin D-sub
(male) point, either connect Bytes Sent
Receive Counts
176
176
7
2 TXD 15
the RS-232 loop Error Counts 0

3 RXD
back connector or
the RS-422/485
RTS/CTS
BAK -- -- --
pass
-- 8
7 CTS connector, depending
8 RTS 1
on which type of F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 9
communications
Wiring Diagram connection is being
used, and press ENT
10
[F5] to start the test.
RS-422/485 Loop-back Connector
Wiring diagrams for
LOOP BACK TEST
Serial Port2:
11
7 CTS 15-pin D-sub both types of loop Bytes Sent 37

8 RTS
(male) back connectors are
Receive Counts
Error Counts
RTS/CTS
0
137
fail
12
9 15 shown on this page.
RXD+ BAK -- -- -- --

11 TXD+
If the test is passing,
the Receive Counts
13
10 will equal the Bytes F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

12
RXD–
TXD– 1 Sent. If the serial 14
port is not working,
Wiring Diagram then the Error
Counts will equal the
A
Bytes Sent. The
RTS/CTS signals B
will also show either
pass or fail as shown
to the right. The test
C
will continue until
the BAK [F1] key is D
pressed.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–15
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Test Menu – PLC Enquiry Test


1 With PLC Enquiry
TEST MENU Test highlighted, TEST MENU
2 2.PLC Enquiry Test
press ENT [F5] to
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
bring up the screen
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
2.PLC
Connect Panel to
PLCEnquiry Test
3.Buzzer Test shown to the right. 3.Buzzer Test
3 4.Touch Panel Test
BAK -- UP DWN
If the PLC is
ENT
4.Touch Panel Test
BAK -- UP DWN ENT
connected to the
4 F1 F2 F3 F4
panel, press ENT
[F5] to start the test.
F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
Four data tests will
5 be performed and
indicated as either
6 PLC ENQUIRY TEST
Test Passed or Test
Failed as shown on
PLC ENQUIRY TEST
DirectLogic K-Sequence DirectLogic K-Sequence
this page. The BAK
7 Data1:Test Passed
Data2:Test Passed
Data3:Test Passed [F1] key can be
Data1:Test Failed
Data2:Test Failed
Data3:Test Failed
Data4:Test Passed pressed to cancel the Data4:Test Failed

8 BAK -- -- --test and/or returned


--

to the previous
BAK -- -- -- --

screen.
9 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

10
11 Test Menu – Buzzer Test With Buzzer Test highlighted, press ENT [F5] to run the test
on the internal audible beeper. The beeper will sequence up
12 TEST MENU
the scale through eight notes and then start over. The BAK
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
2.PLC Enquiry Test
[F1] key can be pressed to cancel the test.
13 3.Buzzer Test
4.Touch Panel Test

14 BAK -- UP DWN ENT

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
A
B
Note: The beeper tone is not selectable. The beeper function can not be turned on or off from this screen,
C refer to the Setting menu.

5–16 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 5: System Setup Screens

Test Menu – Touch Panel Test


With Touch Panel 1
Test highlighted,
TEST MENU
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
press ENT [F5] to
bring up the screen
2
2.PLC Enquiry Test
shown to the right. Press Key to Quit
3.Buzzer Test
4.Touch Panel Test Touch any area of the 3
BAK -- UP DWN ENT screen to visualize the

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
active area of the
touch screen. If the F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
4
touch panel area is
working properly, the 5
screen will blacken at
the area touched. Use
this test to identify
6
any area that is not
responding properly. 7
Press any key [F1 to
F5] to return to the
Test Menu.
8
Note: The Touch Panel Test is available only on C-more Micro Graphic Touch panels (models EA1-S3ML and
EA1-S3MLW).
9
Exit 10
With Exit highlighted, press ENT [F5] to bring up the screen
SETUP MENU shown to the left. You will be given the choice to either 11
1. Do you want to > proceed with exiting the System Setup Screens by pressing
2.
3.
exit from System
Screen?
>
>
[F5] for YES or allowed to cancel by pressing [F1] for NO.
You will be returned to the project screen if answering YES.
12
4. No[F1] / Yes[F5]

BAK -- UP DWN ENT 13


F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 14
If there is no user program loaded into the panel, then a NO
USER PROGRAM message as shown to the left will be
displayed.
A
SETUP MENU
1.Information
2.Setting
>
>
B
NO USER PROGRAM
3.Test Menu
4.Exit
BAK – UP DWN
>

ENT
C
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 5–17
CHAPTER
PLC COMMUNICATIONS
6
In This Chapter...
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–2
Available PLC Protocols: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–2
C-more Micro-Graphic Built-in Port 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–3
C-more Micro-Graphic Optional EA-MG-SP1 Port 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–4
DirectLOGIC PLCs Password Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
PLC Compatibility and Connection Charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
AutomationDirect CLICK PLC: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–5
Direct LOGIC PLCs RS-422A/RS-485A: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–6
Allen-Bradley: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–6
GE, Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–6
Available Purchased Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–20
Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–22
User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–32
RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6–40
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Introduction
1 The C-more® Micro-Graphic panels are capable of communicating with AutomationDirect
CLICK and the entire DirectLOGIC family of PLCs. The panel is capable of communicating
2 using RS232, RS422 and RS485 serial communications and networks. When using the built in
RJ12 serial port, designated as Port 1, on the C-more Micro-Graphic panel to connect with the
CLICK, DL05, DL06, DL105, DL205, D3-350 and DL405 CPUs, your cabling choices are
3 fairly simple.
• DV-1000CBL – connects to CLICK, DL05, DL06, DL105, DL205, D3-350 and D4-450 phone
4 jack.
• D4-1000CBL – connects to all DL405 CPU 15-pin ports.

5 The panel also has the ability to communicate with Allen-Bradley PLCs that support the Allen-
Bradley DF1 and DH485 protocols. Use of the Serial Port with DC Power Adapter module,
EA-MG-SP1, along with the following cables will allow connecting the panel to a majority of
6 Allen-Bradley PLCs.
• EA-MLOGIX-CBL – connects to AB MicroLogix 1000, 1100, 1200 & 1500
7 • EA-SLC-232-CBL – connects to AB SLC 5/03, /04, /05, ControlLogix, CompactLogix, FlexLogix
• EA-PLC5-232-CBL – connects to AB PLC5
8 • EA-DH485-CBL – connects to AB MicroLogix, SLC500, and any PLC using AB AIC device
The PLC Compatibility and Connection Chart tables on the following pages list all of the
9 various PLCs and protocols that can be configured. Other third party PLCs include GE,
Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens. The rest of this chapter is devoted to show the pin
to pin connections of all the available cables plus wring diagrams that the user can refer to in
10 order to construct their own cables, along with wiring diagrams of cables that are not available
for purchase.
11 Note: A maximum cable length of 10 feet between the Micro-Graphic panel and the PLC is recommended
when powering the panel from the PLC.
12 The Serial Port with DC Power Adapter module, EA-MG-SP1, can be used if the application
requires the use of RS-422 or RS-485. The serial port on the adapter, designated as Port 2, can
13 also be wired for RS-232. The use of the adapter permits greater cable lengths. The panel can
also be connected to more than one PLC by using RS-422 or RS-485 wired in a multi-drop
14 configuration. See the example wiring diagrams at the end of this chapter for details.
PLC Drivers
Available PLC Protocols Serial - port1 or port2 Serial - port2 only*
A AutomationDirect CLICK
AutomationDirect K-sequence
Allen-Bradley DF1 Half Duplex
Allen-Bradley DF1 Full Duplex
AutomationDirect DirectNET Allen-Bradley PLC5 DF1

B If you have difficulty determining whether


AutomationDirect Modbus
Modicon Modbus RTU
Entivity Modbus RTU
Allen-Bradley DH485
GE SNPX (90/30, 90/70, Micro 90, VersaMax Micro)
Mitsubishi FX
the particular PLC and/or protocol you are Mitsubishi Q & QnA

C using will work with the C-more series of


Micro-Graphic panels, please contact our
Omron Host Link (C200 Adapter, C500)
Omron FINS Serial (CJ1, CS1)
Siemens PPI (S7-200 CPU)
technical support group at 770-844-4200.
D *Note: Use of serial port2 on C-more 3” Micro-Graphic requires the use of EA-MG-SP1

6–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

C-more Micro-Graphic Built-in Port 1


1
Example of panel’s Port 1
connected to a CLICK PLC 2
C-more 3 Inch
Micro-Graphic Panel 3
CLICK PLC 4
Port 1

5
6
7
DV-1000CBL
serial cable
8
Port 2
9
Port 1 (built-in) 10
C-more
Micro-Graphic
panel
RJ12 serial
communications port 1
11
12
13
14
Pin
1
2
Signal
Logic GND
not used
A
6 5 4 3 2 1 3 RXD (232C)
4
5
TXD (232C)
+5 VDC
B
6 Logic GND

C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–3
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

C-more Micro-Graphic Optional EA-MG-SP1 Port 2


1 Example of panel’s Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter
Optional Port 2 EA-MG-SP1
2 connected to a
DL06 PLC
3
4 Port
2
5 Port
2
DL06 PLC
6
7 C-more to
Direct LOGIC
VGA 15-pin port
C-more
Micro Graphic
serial cable Panel
8 p/n EA-2CBL-1

9 Port 2 (optional)
10 Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1
PLC 15-pin serial
communications port 2

11 8

15 9
1 NOTE: If the DC
power adapter
is installed on
12 the panel, the
adapter must be
powered.
13
14 Expansion
Connector
Pin
1
Signal
Frame GND
Pin
6 LE
Signal Pin
11
Signal
TXD+ (422/485)
2 TXD (232C) 7 CTS (232C) 12 TXD– (422/485)

A 3
4
RXD (232C)
Future
8
9
RTS (232C)
RXD+ (422/485)
13 Term. Resistor
14 do not use
5 Logic GND 10 RXD– (422/485) 15 do not use

B NOTE: Adapter requires 10.8-26.4 VDC supply.

NOTE: The panel has one built-in RJ12 serial communications port (Port 1 - RS-232) and the option to add
C one 15-pin serial communications port (Port 2 - RS-232/422/485) to the panel by installing the EA-MG-SP1
module. Only one of the ports can be used with a connected PLC. The programming software allows the user
to select either Comm. Port1 or Comm. Port2 under the Panel Manager dialog box. When using Port 2 to
D communicate with the connected PLC, Port 1 can still be used with the EA-MG-PGM-CBL Software
Programming Cable Assembly to transfer projects between the PC and panel.

6–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC PLCs Password Protection


1
NOTE: DirectLOGIC PLCs support multi-level password protection of the ladder program. This allows
password protection while not locking the communication port to an operator interface. The multilevel
password can be invoked by creating a password with an upper case "A" followed by seven numeric 2
characters (e.g. A1234567). Please refer to the specific PLC user manual for further details.
3
PLC Compatibility and Connection Charts
The following charts list the possible connections available between C-more 3” Micro-Graphic 4
panels and a variety of PLCs. The charts list which PLC ports can communicate and provide
power to the C-more Micro-Graphic panel through built-in port 1 (RS-232). Also shown is 5
communication through port 1 (RS-232) when utilizing the optional DC Power Adapter EA-
MG-P1. Communications using the optional Serial Port with DC Power Adapter (EA-MG-
SP1) through port 1 or port 2 is illustrated as well.
6
The chart includes the various PLC protocols that can be used with each combination of PLC
port and panel port. 7
The chart lists the recommended cables and/or manufactured devices that can be used to make
up the communications link, and also refers to wiring diagrams that can be used to construct 8
cables for connecting the PLC’s port to the panel’s port.
Following the charts is a list of cables that can be purchased, including their wiring diagrams, 9
and also wiring diagrams that are referenced from the charts that can be used to construct the
referenced cables.The constructed cables are referred to as Diagram 1 through 13 and start on
page 6-32.
10
AutomationDirect CLICK PLC:
AutomationDirect’s practically free PLC, CLICK, can be used with RS-232 2-wire networks.
11
C-more Micro-Graphic panels are an ideal partner for CLICK which:
• Is low cost
12
• Is easy to use
• Standard Modbus communication 13
• Is programmed by free CLICK programming software
• Has comm ports that provide 5 VDC
• Communicates at speeds up to 115.2 Kbps, although the maximum communication speed between 14
a CLICK PLC and a C-more Micro-Graphic panel is 38.4 Kbps.
A
Note: Only one C-more Micro-Graphic panel can be powered by a CLICK PLC. If a 2nd panel is connected
to a different port on the CLICK PLC, an external power supply is required. B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–5
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Direct LOGIC PLCs RS-422A/RS-485A:


When using the RS-422A/RS-485A communications capabilities of the C-more Micro-Graphic
1 EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter (Port 2), the termination resistor is placed
between the RXD– and RXD+ terminals on the PLC side of the connection between the
2 C-more Micro-Graphic panel and PLC. The Termination Resistor value is based on the
characteristic impedance of the cable being used. To enable the built-in 120 Ohm Termination
Resistor, jumper pin 13 (termination resistor) to pin 9 (RXD+) on the C-more 15-pin PLC
3 communications port.

4 Allen-Bradley:
As stated in this chapter’s introduction, the panel also has the ability to communicate with
Allen-Bradley PLCs that support the Allen-Bradley DF1 and DH485 protocols. Use of the
5 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter module, EA-MG-SP1, is required. The chart for the various
Allen-Bradley PLCs includes recommended cables.
6 GE, Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens:
Other 3rd party PLCs can be used with the C-more Micro-Graphic panel with the use of the
7 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter module, EA-MG-SP1. These PLCs are listed in a chart and
various wiring diagrams are shown to allow connectivity.
8
PLC Serial
9 Communications Port 2
Serial Port w/

10 DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1
PLC 15-pin serial
communications port 2

8 1

11 15 9

12
13 Expansion
Connector
Pin
1
Signal
Frame GND
Pin
6 LE
Signal Pin
11
Signal
TXD+ (422/485)
2 TXD (232C) 7 CTS (232C) 12 TXD– (422/485)

14 3
4
5
RXD (232C)
Future
Logic GND
8
9
RTS (232C)
RXD+ (422/485)
10 RXD– (422/485)
13 Term. Resistor
14 do not use
15 do not use

NOTE: Adapter requires 10.8-26.4 VDC supply.

A
B
C
D

6–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

How to use the PLC Compatibility and Connection Charts


1.) Find the PLC Family being used.
2.) Find the particular PLC model in the PLC family.
1
3.) Find the PLC communications port you will be connecting to the C-more Micro-Graphic
panel.
2
4.) Read across the chart to determine if the C-more Micro-Graphic panel’s Port 1 can be used,
or if an optional EA-MG-P1 DC Power Adapter or EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port w/ DC Power 3
Adapter is required, and then determine the cable and other components, manufactured or
user constructed, are required. 4
Example:
5
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
6
Specific Port and Protocol being used.
PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter 7
Powered from an external 24 VDC
Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the
connected PLC’s comm. port.
source using the DC Power
Adapter, EA-MG-P1. 8
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components & 9
Supported Network Type Supported Network Type
D2-230 Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence DV-1000CBL
RS-232 K-sequence DV-1000CBL
RS-232 10
Port 1 K-sequence K-sequence
D2-240
RJ12 - 6 pin
Port 2 K-sequence,
DV-1000CBL
RS-232 K-sequence,
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
11
RJ12 - 6 pin Direct NET Direct NET
Port 1 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
12
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232

D2-250-1
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
13
Port 2 Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
Direct LOGIC DB15HD + FA-15HD + FA-15HD
DL205 (female) RS-232 RS-232 14
Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
A
D2-260
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
B
Port 2 Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
DB15HD + FA-15HD + FA-15HD
(female) RS-232 RS-232 C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–7
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

AutomationDirect CLICK PLC


DirectLOGIC DL05, DL06, D0-DCM Module & DL105 PLCs
1 Panel Powered via RJ12 Port 1 or EA-MG-P1, Port 1 Communications
2 PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
3 Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used.

4 PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter


Powered from an external 24 VDC
Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the source using the DC Power
5 connected PLC’s comm. port. Adapter, EA-MG-P1.
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1

6 Protocol(s)
Supported
Components &
Network Type
Protocol(s)
Supported
Components &
Network Type
AutomationDirect all versions Port 1 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
7 CLICK RJ12 - 6 pin Modbus (CLICK) RS-232 Modbus (CLICK) RS-232
Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence, DV-1000CBL K-sequence, DV-1000CBL
8 all versions
Port 2
RJ12 - 6 pin
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU RS-232 Direct NET,
Modbus RTU RS-232

9 Direct LOGIC
Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
DL05
K-sequence, K-sequence,
10 D0-DCM
Port 2
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
DB15HD + FA-15HD + FA-15HD
(female) RS-232 RS-232
11
Port 1 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
12 RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232

K-sequence, K-sequence,
13 all versions Port 2
DB15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
(female) RS-232 RS-232
14 Direct LOGIC
DL06
Port 1 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
A RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232
K-sequence, K-sequence,
B D0-DCM
Port 2
DB15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
(female) RS-232 RS-232
C
Direct LOGIC all versions
Port 1
K-sequence DV-1000CBL K-sequence DV-1000CBL
D DL105 RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232

6–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

AutomationDirect CLICK PLC


DrectLOGIC DL05, DL06, D0-DCM Module & DL105 PLCs
Panel Powered via EA-MG-SP1, Port 1 or Port 2 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart 2
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used.
3
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter 4
Family CPU Port & Type Powered from an external 24 VDC source using the
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.
Using adapter’s serial Port 2
5
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 DB 15-pin - female
Protocol(s)
Supported
Components &
Network Type
Protocol(s)
Supported
Components &
Network Type
6
AutomationDirect all versions Port 1 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
CLICK RJ12 - 6 pin Modbus (CLICK) RS-232 Modbus (CLICK) RS-232 7
Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence, DV-1000CBL K-sequence, EA-2CBL
all versions
Port 2
RJ12 - 6 pin
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU RS-232 Direct NET,
Modbus RTU RS-232 8
Port 1 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
Direct LOGIC
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232
K-sequence,
RS-232
EA-2CBL-1
9
DL05 Direct NET, RS-232
K-sequence,
D0-DCM Port 2
DB15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
Modbus RTU
* See Diagram 1
RS-422
10
(female) RS-232 * See Diagram 2
Modbus RTU RS-485
Modbus only
11
Port 1 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
RS-232
EA-2CBL-1
12
K-sequence, Modbus RTU RS-232
all versions Port 2
DB15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
* See Diagram 1
RS-422
13
(female) RS-232 * See Diagram 2

Direct
Modbus RTU RS-485
Modbus only
14
LOGICDL06 Port 1 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
RS-232
EA-2CBL-1
A
K-sequence, Modbus RTU RS-232
D0-DCM Port 2
DB15HD
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
* See Diagram 1
RS-422
B
(female) RS-232 * See Diagram 2
Modbus RTU RS-485
Modbus only C
Direct LOGIC Port 1
K-sequence DV-1000CBL K-sequence EA-2CBL
DL105
all versions
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232 D
* Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–9
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC DL205 PLCs, D2-DCM Module and WINPLC


Panel Powered via RJ12 Port 1 or EA-MG-P1, Port 1 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
2 PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
3 Specific Port and Protocol being used.

PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter


4 Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the
Powered from an external 24 VDC
source using the DC Power
connected PLC’s comm. port. Adapter, EA-MG-P1.
5 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
6 Port 1
Supported Network Type
DV-1000CBL
Supported Network Type
DV-1000CBL
D2-230 RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence RS-232 K-sequence RS-232
7 Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence K-sequence
D2-240 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
RS-232 RS-232
8 Port 2
RJ12 - 6 pin
K-sequence,
Direct NET
K-sequence,
Direct NET
Port 1 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
9 RJ12 - 6 pin
K-sequence,
RS-232
K-sequence,
RS-232

D2-250-1 Direct NET, Direct NET,


10 Port 2
DB15HD
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
(female) RS-232 RS-232

11 Direct LOGIC
DL205 Port 1 DV-1000CBL DV-1000CBL
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232
12 K-sequence, K-sequence,
D2-260 Direct NET, Direct NET,
13 Port 2
DB15HD
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
(female) RS-232 RS-232

14
Port 1 K-sequence, K-sequence,
A D2-DCM DB 25 pin
(female)
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
* See Diagram 3
RS-232 Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
* See Diagram 3
RS-232

B WINPLC Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
RS-232 Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
RS-232
* Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.
C
D

6–10 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC DL205 PLCs, D2-DCM Module and WINPLC


Panel Powered via EA-MG-SP1, Port 1 or Port 2 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
2
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used. 3
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter

Family CPU Port & Type Powered from an external 24 VDC source using the
4
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using adapter’s serial Port 2
DB 15-pin - female
5
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &

Port 1
Supported Network Type
DV-1000CBL
Supported Network Type
EA-2CBL
6
D2-230 RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence RS-232 K-sequence RS-232
Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin K-sequence K-sequence
7
D2-240 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
RS-232 RS-232
Port 2
RJ12 - 6 pin
K-sequence,
Direct NET
K-sequence,
Direct NET 8
Port 1 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
RJ12 - 6 pin
K-sequence,
RS-232
K-sequence,
RS-232 9
D2-250-1 Direct NET, Direct NET, EA-2CBL-1
Port 2
DB15HD
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
Modbus RTU RS-232
10
(female) RS-232 * See Diagram 1
RS-422
Direct LOGIC
DL205 Port 1 DV-1000CBL EA-2CBL
11
RJ12 - 6 pin RS-232 RS-232

K-sequence,
K-sequence,
Direct NET, EA-2CBL-1 12
Modbus RTU RS-232
D2-260 Direct NET,
Port 2
DB15HD
Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
+ FA-15HD
* See Diagram 1
RS-422 13
(female) RS-232 * See Diagram 2
Modbus RTU RS-485
Modbus only 14
EA-4CBL-2
Port 1 K-sequence,
D2-DCM DB 25 pin
(female)
Direct NET,
Modbus RTU
* See Diagram 3
RS-232
Direct NET
RS-232
* See Diagram 6 A
RS-422
WINPLC Port 1
RJ12 - 6 pin Modbus RTU DV-1000CBL
RS-232 Modbus RTU EA-2CBL
RS-232 B
* Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–11
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC DL305 PLCs and D3-DCM Module


Panel Powered via RJ12 Port 1 or EA-MG-P1, Port 1 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
2 PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
3 Specific Port and Protocol being used.

PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter


4 Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the
Powered from an external 24 VDC
source using the DC Power
connected PLC’s comm. port. Adapter, EA-MG-P1.
5 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
6 D3-232-DCU
Supported Network Type Supported Network Type

DB 25 pin Not Possible Direct NET * See Diagram 3


RS-232
7 D3-330 or
D3-340
(female)
D3-422-DCU
DB 25 pin Not Possible Not Possible
8 (female)
Port 1 Not Possible Direct NET
9 D3-340
RJ11 - 4 pin
Port 2 Direct NET,
OP-3CBL-1
RS-232
Direct LOGIC RJ11 - 4 pin Not Possible Modbus RTU
10 DL305
Port 1 K-sequence, DV-1000CBL K-sequence, DV-1000CBL
RJ12 - 6 pin Direct NET RS-232 Direct NET RS-232
11 D3-350 Port 2 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3
DB 25 pin Not Possible Direct NET, RS-232
(female) Modbus RTU
12
D3-DCM Port 1 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3
DB 25 pin Direct NET, Direct NET,
13 D3-350 only (female) Modbus RTU RS-232 Modbus RTU RS-232

* Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.
14
A
B
C
D

6–12 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC DL305 PLCs and D3-DCM Module


Panel Powered via EA-MG-SP1, Port 1 or Port 2 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
2
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used. 3
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter

Family CPU Port & Type Powered from an external 24 VDC source using the
4
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using adapter’s serial Port 2
DB 15-pin - female
5
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &

D3-232-DCU
Supported Network Type Supported Network Type
6
DB 25 pin Direct NET * See Diagram 3 Direct NET EA-4CBL-2
RS-232 RS-232
D3-330 or
D3-340
(female)
D3-422-DCU
7
DB 25 pin Not Possible Direct NET * See Diagram 6
(female) RS-422
8
Port 1 Direct NET Direct NET
D3-340
RJ11 - 4 pin
Port 2 Direct NET,
OP-3CBL-1
RS-232 Direct NET,
EA-3CBL
RS-232
9
Direct LOGIC RJ11 - 4 pin Modbus RTU Modbus RTU
DL305
Port 1 K-sequence, DV-1000CBL K-sequence, EA-2CBL
10
RJ12 - 6 pin Direct NET RS-232 Direct NET RS-232
D3-350 Port 2 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3 K-sequence,
EA-4CBL-2
RS-232
11
DB 25 pin Direct NET, RS-232 Direct NET,
(female) Modbus RTU Modbus RTU * See Diagram 4
RS-422
EA-4CBL-2
12
D3-DCM Port 1 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3 RS-232
DB 25 pin Direct NET, Direct NET
D3-350 only (female) Modbus RTU RS-232 * See Diagram 6
RS-422 13
* Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–13
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC DL405 PLCs and D4-DCM Module


Panel Powered via RJ12 Port 1 or EA-MG-P1, Port 1 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
2 PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
3 Specific Port and Protocol being used.

PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter


4 Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the
Powered from an external 24 VDC
source using the DC Power
connected PLC’s comm. port. Adapter, EA-MG-P1.
5 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
6 Supported Network Type
D4-1000CBL
Supported Network Type
D4-1000CBL
Port 0 or DV-1000CBL or DV-1000CBL
DB 15 pin K-sequence K-sequence
7 D4-430
(female) & FA-CABKIT
RS-232
& FA-CABKIT
RS-232
Port 1 DV-1000CBL
8 DB 25 pin
(female)
Not Possible K-sequence,
Direct NET & FA-CABKIT
RS-232

9 Port 0
DB 15 pin K-sequence
D4-1000CBL
or DV-1000CBL K-sequence
D4-1000CBL
or DV-1000CBL
(female) & FA-CABKIT & FA-CABKIT
RS-232 RS-232
10 D4-440
Port 1 DV-1000CBL
DB 25 pin Not Possible K-sequence, & FA-CABKIT
Direct NET
11 (female) RS-232
Direct LOGIC Port 0 D4-1000CBL D4-1000CBL
DL405 or DV-1000CBL or DV-1000CBL
12 DB 15 pin
(female)
K-sequence & FA-CABKIT
RS-232
K-sequence & FA-CABKIT
RS-232

13 Port 1
DB 25 pin Not Possible
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
DV-1000CBL
& FA-CABKIT
D4-450 (female) Modbus RTU RS-232

14 Port 3
DB 25 pin Not Possible Not Possible
(female)
A Port 2
RJ12 - 6 pin
K-sequence,
Direct NET
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
K-sequence,
Direct NET
DV-1000CBL
RS-232

B Port 1 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3


D4-DCM DB 25 pin Direct NET, RS-232 Direct NET, RS-232
(female) Modbus RTU Modbus RTU
C * Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.

6–14 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

DirectLOGIC DL405 PLCs and D4-DCM Module


Panel Powered via EA-MG-SP1, Port 1 or Port 2 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
2
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used. 3
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter

Family CPU Port & Type Powered from an external 24 VDC source using the
4
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using adapter’s serial Port 2
DB 15-pin - female
5
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
Supported Network Type
D4-1000CBL
Supported Network Type
6
Port 0 or DV-1000CBL EA-4CBL-1
DB 15 pin K-sequence K-sequence

D4-430
(female) & FA-CABKIT
RS-232
RS-232
7
EA-4CBL-2
Port 1 DV-1000CBL
DB 25 pin
(female)
K-sequence,
Direct NET & FA-CABKIT
RS-232
K-sequence,
Direct NET
RS-232
* See Diagram 4 8
RS-422
Port 0
DB 15 pin K-sequence
D4-1000CBL
or DV-1000CBL K-sequence EA-4CBL-1 9
(female) & FA-CABKIT RS-232
RS-232
D4-440
Port 1 DV-1000CBL
EA-4CBL-2
RS-232
10
DB 25 pin K-sequence, & FA-CABKIT K-sequence,
Direct NET Direct NET * See Diagram 4
(female) RS-232
RS-422 11
Direct LOGIC Port 0 D4-1000CBL
DL405 or DV-1000CBL EA-4CBL-1
DB 15 pin
(female)
K-sequence & FA-CABKIT
RS-232
K-sequence RS-232 12
EA-4CBL-2
Port 1
DB 25 pin
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
DV-1000CBL
& FA-CABKIT
K-sequence,
Direct NET,
RS-232
* See Diagram 4
13
D4-450 (female) Modbus RTU RS-232 Modbus RTU
RS-422
Port 3
DB 25 pin Not Possible
K-sequence,
Direct NET, * See Diagram 5
RS-422
14
(female) Modbus RTU
Port 2
RJ12 - 6 pin
K-sequence,
Direct NET
DV-1000CBL
RS-232
K-sequence,
Direct NET
EA-2CBL
RS-232
A
Port 1 K-sequence, * See Diagram 3
EA-4CBL-2
RS-232
B
D4-DCM DB 25 pin Direct NET, RS-232 Direct NET
(female) Modbus RTU * See Diagram 6

* Note: Wiring Diagrams for user contructed cables start on page 6-32.
RS-422 C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–15
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Allen-Bradley PLCs
Panel Powered via PLC’s Port or EA-MG-P1, Port 1 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
2 PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
3 Specific Port and Protocol being used.

PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter


4 Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the
Powered from an external 24 VDC
source using the DC Power
connected PLC’s comm. port. Adapter, EA-MG-P1.
5 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
6 8-pin
Supported Network Type Supported Network Type

Allen-Bradley 1000, 1100, mini-din port


7 MicroLogix 1200, 1500 RJ45 8-pin
phone plug
5/03, 5/04, 9-pin
8 Allen-Bradley
SLC500
5/05
5/01, 5/02,
D-sub port
RJ45 8-pin
5/03 phone plug
9 Allen-Bradley
ControlLogix
all 9-pin
D-sub port
Not Possible Not Possible
10 Allen-Bradley
CompactLogix
all 9-pin
D-sub port

11 Allen-Bradley
FlexLogix
all 9-pin
D-sub port

12 Allen-Bradley all
25-pin
D-sub port
PLC5 RJ45 8-pin
13 phone plug

14
A
B
C
D

6–16 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Allen-Bradley PLCs
Panel Powered via EA-MG-SP1, Port 1 or Port 2 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
2
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used. 3
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter

Family CPU Port & Type Powered from an external 24 VDC source using the
4
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.
Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using adapter’s serial Port 2
DB 15-pin - female
5
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &

8-pin
Supported Network Type Supported Network Type
DF1 Full Duplex, EA-MLOGIX-CBL
6
Allen-Bradley 1000, 1100, mini-din port DF1 Half Duplex RS-232
MicroLogix 1200, 1500 RJ45 8-pin
phone plug DH485/AIC/AIC+ EA-DH485-CBL
RS-232
7
5/03, 5/04, 9-pin DF1 Full Duplex, EA-SLC-232-CBL
Allen-Bradley
SLC500
5/05
5/01, 5/02,
D-sub port
RJ45 8-pin
DF1 Half Duplex RS-232
EA-DH485-CBL
8
5/03 phone plug DH485/AIC/AIC+ RS-232
Allen-Bradley all 9-pin DF1 Full Duplex, EA-SLC-232-CBL 9
ControlLogix D-sub port DF1 Half Duplex RS-232

Allen-Bradley all 9-pin


Not Possible
DF1 Full Duplex, EA-SLC-232-CBL 10
CompactLogix D-sub port DF1 Half Duplex RS-232

Allen-Bradley all 9-pin DF1 Full Duplex, EA-SLC-232-CBL 11


FlexLogix D-sub port DF1 Half Duplex RS-232

25-pin
EA-PLC5-232-CBL
RS-232
12
DF1 Full Duplex
Allen-Bradley D-sub port ** See Diagram 16
PLC5
all
RJ45 8-pin
RS-422
EA-DH485-CBL
13
phone plug DH485/AIC/AIC+ RS-232
** Note: Wiring Diagrams for user constructed cables start on page 6-32. 14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–17
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

GE, Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens PLCs


Panel Powered via PLC’s Port or EA-MG-P1, Port 1 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
2 PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
3 Specific Port and Protocol being used.

PLC Port Powered DC Power Adapter


4 Family CPU Port & Type Powered with 5 VDC from the
Powered from an external 24 VDC
source using the DC Power
connected PLC’s comm. port. Adapter, EA-MG-P1.
5 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1 Using panel’s RJ12 port 1
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
6 Supported Network Type Supported Network Type

90/30, 90/70 15-pin


D-sub port
7 RJ45
GE Micro 90, Port 1
8 VersaMax
Micro
15-pin
D-sub port
Port 2
9 25-pin
D-sub port
Melsec
10 Mitsubishi FX Series
8-pin
mini-din port
11 C200 25-pin Not Possible Not Possible
(Adapter), D-sub port
C500
12 Omron
CJ1, CS1, 25-pin
CQM1, D-sub port
13 CPM1
984 CPU,
Quantum
14 Modicon
113 CPU,
AEG
Modicon
varies
Micro Series
A 110 CPU

S7-200 9-pin
Siemens D-sub port
B CPU 0 or 1

C
D

6–18 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

GE, Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens PLCs


Panel Powered via EA-MG-SP1, Port 1 or Port 2 Communications
1
PLC Compatibility & Connection Chart
PLC C-more Micro-Graphic Panel
2
Panel to PLC Cabling Components Required for
Specific Port and Protocol being used. 3
SerialExternal
Port with
DC DC Power
Power Adapter
Supply

Family CPU PLC Port & 4


Type Powered from an external 24 VDC source.

Using panel’s RJ12 Port1 Using panel’s Port2


DB 15-pin - female
5
Protocol(s) Components & Protocol(s) Components &
Supported Network Type Supported Network Type 6
90/30, 90/70 15-pin EA-90-30-CBL
D-sub port RS-422
RJ45 ** See Diagram 7
GE Port 1 SNPX 12
Micro 90, RS-232
VersaMax
Micro 15-pin
EA-90-30-CBL
8
D-sub port
Port 2 RS-422

25-pin EA-MITSU-CBL
9
Melsec D-sub port RS-422
FX Series 8-pin
mini-din port
CPU Direct
EA-MITSU-CBL-1
RS-422
10
Mitsubishi
9-pin
D-sub port
** See Diagram
14
RS-232C
11
Q / QnA Q / QnA
6-pin
mini-din port Not Possible
** See Diagram
15
RS-232C
12
C200
(Adapter),
C500
25-pin
D-sub port Host Link EA-OMRON-CBL
RS-232
13
CJ1, CS1,
Omron
CQM1,
CPM1, 9-pin Host Link ** See Diagram
7&8
14
CPM2 D-sub port FINS RS-232
C200 CPU
984 CPU,
A
Quantum
Modicon
113 CPU,
AEG varies Modbus RTU
** See Diagram
9, 10 & 11
B
Modicon RS-232
Micro Series
110 CPU C
S7-200 9-pin ** See Diagram
Siemens CPU D-sub port
0 or 1
PPI 13
RS-485 D
** Note: Wiring Diagrams for user constructed cables start on page 6-32.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–19
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables


1 Cable Description Cable Part No. Cable Description Cable Part No.
Cables used with optional serial port 2
Cables for direct connect to panel’s serial port 1
2 (Panel powered from PLC’s serial port.)
(Panel powered from optional Serial Port w/ DC Power
Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.)
AutomationDirect CLICK PLC, Direct
AutomationDirect CLICK PLC, Direct
3 LOGIC PLC RJ-12 port, DL05, DL06,
DL105, DL205, D3-350, D4-450 & H2- DV-1000CBL
LOGIC PLC RJ-12 port, DL05, DL06,
DL105, DL205, D3-350, D4-450 & EA-2CBL
H2-WinPLC (RS-232C).
WinPLC
4 (RS-232C) Direct LOGIC (VGA Style) 15-pin port,
DL06, D2-250 (250-1), D2-260
(RS-232C).
EA-2CBL-1

Direct LOGIC PLC RJ-11 port, D3-340


5 Direct LOGIC DL405 PLC 15-pin D-sub
port, DL405
(RS-232C)
D4-1000CBL (RS-232C). EA-3CBL
Direct LOGIC DL405 PLC 15-pin D-sub
EA-4CBL-1
6 port, DL405 (RS-232C).
Direct LOGIC PLC 25-pin D-sub port,
Direct LOGIC (VGA Style) 15-pin port, DL405, D3-350, DL305 DCU and all DCM’s EA-4CBL-2
DL06, D2-250 (250-1), D2-260
7 (RS-232C)
Use with DV-1000CBL cable.
FA-15HD (RS-232C).
Allen-Bradley MicroLogix 1000, 1100,
EA-MLOGIX-CBL
1200 & 1500 (RS-232C)
8 Direct LOGIC PLC 15-pin D-sub port,
Allen-Bradley SLC 5-03/04/05,
ControlLogix, CompactLogix, FlexLogix EA-SLC-232-CBL
DL405 DF1 port (RS-232C)
FA-CABKIT
9 (RS-232C).
Use with DV-1000CBL cable.
Allen-Bradley PLC-5 DF1 port
(RS-232C) EA-PLC5-232-CBL
Allen-Bradley MicroLogix, SLC 5-01/02/03,
EA-DH485-CBL
10 Cables for direct connect to panel’s serial port 1
PLC5 DH485 port (RS-232C)
GE 90/30 and 90/70, Micro 90, VersaMax
(Panel powered from either optional DC Power Micro (Port 2) 15-pin D-sub port EA-90-30-CBL
11 Adapter, EA-MG-P1, or Serial Port w/ DC Power
Adapter, EA-MG-SP1.)
(RS-422A)
MITSUBISHI FX Series 25-pin port
EA-MITSU-CBL
(RS-422A)
12 Direct LOGIC PLC RJ-11 port, D3-340
OP-3CBL-1
MITSUBISHI FX Series 8-pin mini-DIN
(RS-422A) EA-MITSU-CBL-1
(RS-232C). OMRON Host Link (C200 Adapter, C500)
EA-OMRON-CBL
13 (RS-232C)

14
A
B Part No. EA-2CBL Part No. EA-2CBL-1 Part No. EA-3CBL

C
D
Part No. EA-4CBL-1 Part No. EA-4CBL-2

6–20 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables (cont’d)


1
2
Part No. DV-1000CBL Part No. OP-3CBL-1 Part No. FA-15HD 3
4
5
6
Part No. FA-CABKIT Part No. D4-1000CBL 7
8
9
10
Part No. EA-MLOGIX-CBL Part No. EA-SLC-232-CBL Part No. EA-PLC5-232-CBL
11
12
13
14
Part No. EA-DH485-CBL Part No. EA-90-30-CBL
A
B
C
Part No. EA-MITSU-CBL Part No. EA-MITSU-CBL-1 Part No. EA-OMRON-CBL
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–21
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams


1 The following series of wiring diagrams show the connectors and wiring details for the
communication cables that are used between the C-more Micro-Graphic panels and various
2 PLCs. Part numbers are included with the pre-made cables that can be purchased from
AutomationDirect. The information presented will allow the user to construct their own cables
if so desired.
3 CLICK & Direct LOGIC: EA-2CBL
4 Productivity Series, CLICK and Direct Logic PLC RJ12 port:
DL05, DL06, DL105, DL205, DL350, DL450, H2-WINPLC
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter
To PLC
RJ12 Port RS-232C (p/n EA-2CBL)
5
RJ12 6-pin
6 Phone Plug
(6P6C) Wiring Diagram 8 = do not use
15-pin
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
1 = Sig GND 7 = do not use 14 = do not use
2 = do not use 4 3
7 3 = RXD
4 = TXD
TXD
RXD 3 2
RXD
TXD
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
15 13 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
5 = do not use GND 1 5 3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
123456
8 6 = do not use
shield 1 2 = TXD (232C)
1 = Frame GND
1 9 = do not use

Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

9 Note: Only one C-more Micro-Graphic panel can be powered by an AutomationDirect PLC. If connecting
C-more Micro-Graphic panels to more than one port on and AutomationDirect PLC, the additional panel
10 must use an external power supply.

11 Direct LOGIC:
EA-2CBL-1
12 To PLC
15-Pin HD Port
Direct Logic PLC (VGA style) 15-pin HD port:
D2-250, D2-250-1, D2-260, DL06
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter
RS-232C (p/n EA-2CBL-1)
13
15-pin Wiring Diagram 15-pin
14 8 = do not use
HD D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
TXD
RXD
2
3
3 RXD
2 TXD
8 = do not use
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
7 = Sig GND 15 14 = do not use 7 = do not use 15 14 = do not use
6 = do not use 13 = do not use GND 7 5 6 = donot use 13 = do not use
A 5 = CTS
4 = RTS
12 = do not use
11 = do not use RTS
4 5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
3 = RXD 1 6 10 = do not use CTS 5 3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
2 = TXD 9 = do not use 2 = TXD (232C) 1
B 1 = +5 VDC - N/C
HD = High Density shield 1 1 = Frame GND
9 = do not use

Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

C
D

6–22 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


Direct LOGIC:
1
EA-3CBL
Direct Logic PLC RJ11 port: D3-340 To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
2
RS-232C (p/n EA-3CBL) with DC Power Adapter
To PLC
RJ11 Port 3
RJ11 4-pin
Phone Plug
(4P4C) Wiring Diagram 8 = do not use
15-pin
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
4
7 = do not use 14 = do not use
1 = Sig ground
2 = do not use
TXD
RXD
4
3
3
2
RXD
TXD
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
15 13 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
5
3 = RXD
GND 1 5 3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
4 = TXD 1234
shield 1 2 = TXD (232C)
1 = Frame GND
1 9 = do not use 6
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–23
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Direct LOGIC:
EA-4CBL-1
2 To PLC Direct Logic PLC 15-pin D-sub port: DL405, To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
15-Pin Port RS-232C (p/n EA-4CBL-1) with DC Power Adapter
3
Wiring Diagram
4 15-pin
TXD 2 3 RXD
15-pin
RXD 3 2 TXD
D-sub D-sub
5 8 = YOM Sense (male)
7 = CTS
6 = do not use
15
15 = Logic GND
14 = Logic GND
13 = Logic GND
online
GND 13
4 5 8 = do not used (male)
7 = do not used
6 = do not used 15
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
13 = do not use
5 = do not use 12 = do not use GND 14 5 = Logic GND 12 = do not use
6 4 = Online
3 = RXD (232C)
2 = TXD (232C)
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
GND 15
YOP 1
4 = do not used
3 = RXD (232C)
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
2 = TXD (232C) 1 9 = do not use
1 = YOP Sense 1 7 1 = Frame GND
7 See PLC user manual
for pin out details.
CTS
YOM 8

shield 1

8 Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

9 EA-4CBL-2
10 To PLC
25-Pin Port
Direct Logic PLC 25-pin D-sub port: DL405, D3-350,
DL305 DCU, and all DCMs,
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter
RS-232C (p/n EA-4CBL-2)
11
12 13 = do not use
25-pin
D-sub
(male) 25 = do not use TXD 2
Wiring Diagram

3 RXD 8 = do not use


15-pin
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
12 = do not use 25 24 = do not use 3 2 7 = do not use 14 = do not use
23 = do not use RXD TXD
13 11 = do not use
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
22 = do not use GND 7
21 = do not use 4
5
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
15 13 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
8 = do not use RTS
7 = Signal GND 20 = do not use 3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
19 = do not use CTS 5
14 6 = do not use
5 = CTS
4 = RTS
18 = do not use
17 = do not use shield 1
2 = TXD (232C) 1
1 = Frame GND
9 = do not use

3 = RXD 16 = do not use


A 2 = TXD
1 = do not use
1 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

B
C
D

6–24 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1
CLICK & Direct LOGIC: DV-1000CBL
To PLC Power Supplied to Panel through Cable from AutomationDirect CLICK PLC or To C-more
2
RJ12 Port Micro-Graphic
Direct LOGIC PLC, RS-232C (p/n DV-1000CBL) Serial Port 1
3
10 feet [3.0 m] Maximum
Wiring Diagram 4
RJ12 6-pin GND 6 1 GND RJ12 6-pin
1 = Sig GND
2 = +5 VDC
Phone Plug
(6P6C) TXD
RXD
4
3
3
4
RXD
TXD
Phone Plug
(6P6C) 1 = Sig GND
2 = not used
5
3 = RXD 3 = RXD
2 5
4 = TXD
5 = not used
6 = Sig GND
+5 V
GND 1 6
+5 V
GND
4 = TXD
5 = +5 VDC
6 = Sig GND
6
123456 123456

7
Note: Only one C-more Micro-Graphic panel can be powered by an AutomationDirect PLC. If connecting
C-more Micro-Graphic panels to more than one port on and AutomationDirect PLC, the additional panel
must use an external power supply.
8
9
Direct LOGIC: OP-3CBL-1 10
Direct Logic PLC RJ11 port: D3-340 Port 1 & 2 To C-more
Micro-Graphic
To PLC
RJ11 Port
RS-232C (p/n OP-3CBL-1) Serial Port 1
11
RJ11 4-pin
Phone Plug
(4P4C) Wiring Diagram
RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug
(6P6C)
12
1 = Sig GND
1 = RXD
2 = TXD
RXD
TXD
1
2
4
3
TXD
RXD
2 = not used
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
13
3 = do not use 5 = +5 VDC
GND 4 1
4 = Sig GND 1234 123456 6 = Sig GND
14
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–25
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Allen-Bradley: EA-MLOGIX-CBL
2 To AB MicroLogix RS-232
communication channel
Allen-Bradley MicroLogix™ 1000/1100/1200/1500
RS-232C (p/n EA-MLOGIX-CBL)
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

3
15-pin
4 1 = do not use
2 = Sig GND
Mini Din
8-pin Male Wiring Diagram 8 = do not use
7 = do not use
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
3 = do not use TXD 7 3 RXD 6 = do not use 15 13 = do not use
0.290”

5 4 = RXD
5 = do not use
6 = do not use
3
6
4

1 2
7
5
8

RXD 4
2
2
5
TXD
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
0.35” GND 10 = do not use
7 = TXD DIA. Nonstandard 1 2 = TXD (232C) 1 9 = do not use
6 8 = do not use keying shield
1 = Frame GND
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

7 EA-SLC-232-CBL
To PLC
Allen-Bradley SLC 5-03/04/05, ControlLogix, CompactLogix, To C-more Micro-Graphic

8 9-Pin Port FlexLogix, DF1, RS-232C (p/n EA-SLC-232-CBL) EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

9 9-pin 15-pin
D-sub D-sub
(female) Wiring Diagram 8 = do not use (male)
10 1 = do not use 1
2 = RXD
6 = do not use TXD 3 3
7 = do not use
RXD 6 = do not use 15
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
13 = do not use
7 = do not use 2 2 5 = Logic GND 12 = do not use
3 = TXD 8 = do not use RXD TXD
11 4 = do not use
5 = Signal GND 9
9 = do not use GND 5
shield
5
1
4 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
2 = TXD (232C) 1
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
1 = Frame GND

12 Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

EA-PLC5-232-CBL
13 To PLC Allen-Bradley PLC5, DF1, To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
25-Pin Port
RS-232C (p/n EA-PLC5-232-CBL) with DC Power Adapter
14
A 25-pin
D-sub
Wiring Diagram 15-pin
D-sub
13 = do not use (male) 25 = do not use TXD 2 3 RXD 8 = do not use
12 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
25 24 = do not use
B 11 = do not use
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
23 = do not use RXD
22 = do not use GND 7
3 2 TXD 7 = do not use
5
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
14 = do not use
15 13 = do not use
12 = do not use
21 = do not use 1 4 = do not use 11 = do not use
8 = do not use shield
20 = do not use
C 7 = Signal GND
6 = do not use
5 = do not use
19 = do not use
18 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
2 = TXD (232C) 1
1 = Frame GND
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
4 = do not use 17 = do not use

D 3 = RXD
2 = TXD
1 = do not use
1
16 = do not use
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

6–26 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1
Allen-Bradley: EA-DH485-CBL
To AB SLC500
Allen-Bradley SLC500™, 5/01, /02, /03 DH-485
Point-to-Point
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter
2
DH-485 Port RS-485A (p/n EA-DH485-CBL)
3
Wiring Diagram

RJ45 8-pin
Phone Plug
(8P8C)
13 Term.
15-pin 4
1 = TXD/RXD+ D-sub
2 = TXD/RXD– TXD/RXD+ 1 9 RD+ 8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
3 = do not use
4 = Signal GND
TXD/RXD– 2 10
11
RD–
7 = do not use
6 = LE
5 = Logic GND
15
14 = do not use
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS485)
5
5 = LE SD+
4 = do not use 11 = SD+ (RS485)
6 = do not use
7 = Signal GND
8 = do not use LE * 5
12
6
SD–
LE *
3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
10 = RD– (RS485)
9 = RD+ (RS485)
6
4 1 = Frame GND
GND
GND 7
shield
5
1
* Note: The LE signal is wired in the cable
as shown, but not required for
point-to-point communications.
7
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 9842 shielded cable or equivalent.

Allen-Bradley SLC500™, 5/01, /02, /03 DH-485/AIC to Multiple C-more Micro-Graphic Panels
8
RS-485A (using C-more cable p/n EA-DH485-CBL)
Allen-Bradley
SLC 500 Modular
DH-485 Link
9
(See manufacturer’s litature for details.)
PLC Controller

DH-485

Peripheral
DH-485

Peripheral
10
J2 J2

Channel 1 must be
set to DH485.
CPU
J1

Power
CPU
J1

Power
11
AB 1747-AIC
DH485 Link Coupler
AB 1747-AIC
DH485 Link Coupler
12
AB 1747-C11 A
Cable

Serial Port w/ Serial Port w/


13
DC Power Adapter DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1 EA-MG-SP1
14
A
C-more
Micro-Graphic
Panel
C-more
Micro-Graphic
Panel
B
C-more C-more
C
EA-DH485-CBL EA-DH485-CBL
Cable Cable

Note: The above diagram shows connecting multiple C-more Micro-Graphic panels to an Allen-Bradley DH485/AIC network
using the AB DH485 Link Coupler, p/n 1747-AIC. Select the “Allen-Bradly DH485/AIC SLC500 MircroLogix” driver in the
D
C-more Micro Programming Software when starting the project. Also, set the AB channel configuration for DH485.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–27
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Allen-Bradley:
2 Allen-Bradley SLC500™ 5/03 DH-485/AIC to Multiple C-more Micro-Graphic Panels
(using C-more cables p/n EA-MLOGIX-CBL, EA-SLC-232-CBL)

3 Allen-Bradley
SLC 5/03 Modular
DH-485 Link
(See manufacturer’s litature for details.)
PLC Controller

4
5 Channel 0 must be
set to DH485.

AB 1761-NET-AIC AB 1761-NET-AIC

6 AIC + Advanced
Interface Converter
AIC + Advanced
Interface Converter

C-more

7 Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1
Serial Port w/
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1
EA-MLOGIX-CBL
Cable

AB 1747-CP3
RS-232 Cable

8
To additional
C-more

9 C-more
Micro-Graphic
C-more
Micro-Graphic
Touch Panel

Panel Panel

10
11 C-more
EA-MLOGIX-CBL
Cable
C-more
EA-SLC-232-CBL
Cable

12 Note: The above diagram shows connecting multiple C-more Micro-Graphic panels to an Allen-Bradley DH485/AIC network using the
AB AIC+ Advanced Interface Converter, p/n 1761-NET-AIC. Select the “Allen-Bradly DH485/AIC SLC500 MircroLogix” driver
in the C-more Micro Programming Software when starting the project. Also, set the AB channel configuration for DH485.

13
14
A
B
C
D

6–28 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


GE:
1
EA-90-30-CBL
To PLC GE 90/30, 90/70, Micro 90 and VersaMax Micro (Port 2) To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
2
15-Pin Port 15-pin D-sub port, RS-422A (p/n EA-90-30-CBL) with DC Power Adapter
3
15-pin
D-sub 13
Wiring Diagram 13
9
Term. 15-pin
D-sub
4
8 = CTS(B’) 15 = CTS(A’) SD(B) RD+
8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
7 = Logic GND (male)
6 = do not use
5 = +5V
15
14 = do not use
13 = SD(B)
12 = SD(A)
SD(A)
RD(B’) 11
12 10
11
RD– 7 = do not use
SD+ 6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
15
14 = do not use
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS422)
5
4 = do not use 11 = RD(B’) RD(A’) 10 12 SD– 4 = do not use 11 = SD+ (RS422)
3 = do not use
2 = do not use
1 = do not use 1
10 = RD(A’)
9 = do not use GND
CTS(B’)
7
8
5 3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
10 = RD– (RS422)
9 = RD+ (RS422)
6
1 = Frame GND
15
CTS(A’)
+5V 5
1
7
shield
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–29
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Mitsubishi:
EA-MITSU-CBL
2 To PLC Mitsubishi FX Series 25-pin D-sub port, To C-more Micro-Graphic
25-Pin Port EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
RS-422A (p/n EA-MITSU-CBL) with DC Power Adapter
3
4 25-pin
D-sub
Wiring Diagram
13 Term. 15-pin
D-sub
13 = do not use (male) 25 = do not use SD+ 3 9 RD+
8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
5 12 = do not use
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
25 24 = do not use SD– 16
23 = do not use
22 = do not use RD+ 2
10 RD– 7 = do not use
11 SD+ 6 = do not use 15
14 = do not use
13 = Termination
9 = do not use 21 = do not use RD– 15 5 = Logic GND 12 = SD– (RS422)
8 = do not use 12 SD– 4 = do not use
6 7 = Signal GND
6 = do not use
5 = do not use
20 = do not use
19 = do not use GND
18 = do not use GND 4
7 5 3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
11 = SD+ (RS422)
10 = RD– (RS422)
9 = RD+ (RS422)
17 = do not use 1 = Frame GND
4 = Signal GND 1
7 3 = SD+ (RS422)
2 = RD+ (RS422) 1
1 = do not use
16 = SD– (RS422)
15 = RD– (RS422)
14 = do not use
shield

Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.
8
9 EA-MITSU-CBL-1
To C-more Micro-Graphic
Mitsubishi FX Series 8-pin MINI-DIN, EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
10 To PLC
8-Pin Port
RS-422A (p/n EA-MITSU-CBL-1) with DC Power Adapter

11 Mini Din Wiring Diagram 13 Term. 15-pin


8-pin Male D-sub
1 = RD– (RS-422) 7 9
12 2 = RD+ (RS-422)
3 = Sig GND
4 = SD– (RS-422)
6 7 8
SD+
SD– 4
2
10
11
RD+
RD–
8 = do not use
7 = do not use
6 = do not use
(male)

15
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
13 = Termination
3 4 5 RD+ SD+ 5 = Logic GND 12 = SD– (RS422)
5 = do not use 1 2

13 6 = do not use
7 = SD+ (RS-422)
8 = do not use
RD–
GND
1
3
12
5
SD– 4 = do not use
3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
11 = SD+ (RS422)
10 = RD– (RS422)
9 = RD+ (RS422)
shield 1 1 = Frame GND

14 Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.

A
B
C
D

6–30 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

Available Purchased Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1
Omron: EA-OMRON-CBL
To PLC
25-Pin Port
Omron Host Link (C200 Adapter, C500),
RS-232C (p/n EA-OMRON-CBL)
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
2
with DC Power Adapter

3
Wiring Diagram

13 = do not use
25-pin
D-sub
(male) 25 = do not use TXD 2 3 RXD 8 = do not use
15-pin
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
4
12 = do not use 25 24 = do not use 3 2 7 = do not use 14 = do not use
11 = do not use 23 = do not use RXD TXD
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
22 = do not use GND 7
21 = do not use 4
5
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
15 13 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
5
8 = do not use
7 = Signal GND 20 = do not use RTS 3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
19 = do not use CTS 5
6 = do not use
5 = CTS
4 = RTS
18 = do not use
17 = do not use shield 1
2 = TXD (232C) 1
1 = Frame GND
9 = do not use
6
3 = RXD 16 = do not use
2 = TXD
1 = do not use
1 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–31
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams


1 Diagram 1 User Constructed
2 To PLC
15-Pin Port
Direct LOGIC DL06, D2-250, D2-250-1, D2-260
(all Port 2) RS-422A
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

3
4 15-pin
HD D-sub
TXD+ 9
Wiring Diagram 13
9
Term.
RD+
15-pin
D-sub
(male) 8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
TXD– 10 10 RD– 7 = do not use 14 = do not use
5 8 = do not use
7 = Sig GND
6 = RXD–
15
15 = CTS–
14 = CTS+
RXD+ 13
6
11
12
SD+
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
15
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS422)
RXD– SD– 4 = do not use 11 = SD+ (RS422)
5 = do not use 13 = RXD+
7 5 3 = do not use
6 4 = do not use
3 = do not use 1 6
12 = RTS-
11 = RTS+
10 = TXD–
GND
RTS– 12
2 = do not use 1
1 = Frame GND
10 = RD– (RS422)
9 = RD+ (RS422)
2 = do not use CTS– 15
1 = do not use 9 = TXD+
7 RTS+
CTS+
11
14
shield 1

8 Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.

9 Diagram 2 User Constructed


Direct LOGIC DL06, D2-260 (both Port 2) To C-more Micro-Graphic
To PLC
10 15-Pin Port RS-485A
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

11 Wiring Diagram
15-pin 13 Term. 15-pin

12 HD D-sub
(male) RXD+
TXD+
13
9
9
11
RD+
8 = do not use
SD+ 7 = do not use
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
8 = do not use 15
10 10 6 = do not use 13 = Termination
15 = CTS– TXD– RD–
13 7 = Sig GND
6 = RXD–
5 = do not use
15
14 = CTS+
13 = RXD+
RXD– 6
7
12
5
5 = Logic GND
SD– 4 = do not use
3 = do not use
12 = SD– (RS485)
11 = SD+ (RS485)
10 = RD– (RS485)
4 = do not use 12 = RTS- GND
2 = do not use 1 9 = RD+ (RS485)
11 = RTS+ 12
14 3 = do not use
2 = do not use
1 = do not use
1 6
10 = TXD–
9 = TXD+
RTS–
CTS– 15
1 = Frame GND

RTS+ 11

A CTS+ 14
shield 1

B Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 9842 shielded cable or equivalent.

C NOTE: The RS-422 and RS-485 wiring diagrams shown above are not for multi-drop networks involving
connecting more than one PLC to a panel. Refer to the wiring diagram examples starting on page 6-38 if more
than one PLC will be connected to a panel.
D

6–32 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1
Diagram 3 User Constructed
To DCM
25-Pin Port
Direct Logic D2-DCM 25-pin D-sub port:
RS-232C
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
2
with DC Power Adapter

3
Wiring Diagram

13 = do not use
25-pin
D-sub
(male) 25 = do not use TXD 2 3 RXD RJ12 6-pin
4
12 = do not use 25 24 = do not use 3 4 TXD Phone Plug
11 = do not use 23 = do not use RXD 1 = Sig GND
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
8 = do not use
22 = do not use GND 7
21 = do not use 4
6
(6P6C)
2 = do not use
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
5
7 = Signal GND 20 = do not use RTS
19 = do not use CTS 5 5 = +5 VDC
6 = +5 VDC
5 = CTS
4 = RTS
18 = do not use +5 V 6
17 = do not use
5 +5 V
123456
6 = Sig GND
6
3 = RXD 16 = do not use shield
2 = TXD
1 = do not use
1 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.
7
8
Diagram 4 User Constructed
To PLC
25-Pin Port
Direct LOGIC D4-430/D4-440/D4-450 Port 1 To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
9
and D3-350 Port 2, all RS-422A with DC Power Adapter

10
13 = do not use
25-pin
D-sub
25 = do not use 14
Wiring Diagram 13
9
Term. 15-pin
D-sub
11
(male) TXD+ RD+
12 = do not use 24 = do not use 8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
11 = CTS+
10 = RXD–
(RS422)
25 23 = CTS–
22 = do not use
TXD–
RXD+
16
9
10
11
RD– 7 = do not use
SD+
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
15
14 = do not use
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS422)
12
21 = do not use 10 12
9 = RXD+ RXD– SD– 4 = do not use 11 = SD+ (RS422)
20 = do not use
(RS422)
8 = do not use
7=0V
19 = RTS+
18 = RTS–
0V
RTS–
7
18
5 3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
1 = Frame GND
10 = RD– (RS422)
9 = RD+ (RS422) 13
6 = do not use 17 = do not use
CTS– 23
5 = do not use
4 = do not use
3 = do not use 1
16 = TXD–
(RS422)
15 = do not use
RTS+ 19
11
14
2 = do not use 14 = TXD+ CTS+
1 = do not use 1
(RS422) shield

Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.
A
B
NOTE: The RS-422 wiring diagram shown above is not for multi-drop networks involving connecting more
than one PLC to a panel. Refer to the wiring diagram example on page 6-38 if more than one PLC will be
C
connected to a panel.
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–33
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Diagram 5 User Constructed
2 To PLC
25-Pin Port
Direct LOGIC D4-450 Port 3 To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
RS-422A with DC Power Adapter

3 RTS and CTS are not present on this port.

4 13 = TXD–
25-pin
D-sub
(male)
25 = RXD–
(RS422) TXD+ 12
Wiring Diagram 13
9
Term. 15-pin
D-sub
(RS422) RD+ (male)
8 = do not use 15 = do not use
12 = TXD+ 24 = RXD+ 13 10
5 (RS422)
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
25 (RS422)
23 = do not use
TXD–
RXD+ 24 11
RD– 7 = do not use
SD+
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
15
14 = do not use
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS422)
22 = do not use RXD– 25 12 SD– 4 = do not use
9 = do not use 21 = do not use 11 = SD+ (RS422)
6 8 = do not use
7=0V
6 = do not use
20 = do not use
19 = do not use
0V 7
shield
5
1
3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
1 = Frame GND
10 = RD– (RS422)
9 = RD+ (RS422)

5 = do not use 18 = do not use

7 4 = do not use
3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
17 = do not use
16 = do not use
15 = do not use
1 = do not use 14 = do not use

8 Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.

9 Diagram 6 User Constructed


To PLC Direct LOGIC D2-DCM*, D3-DCM* & D4-DCM* To C-more Micro-Graphic

10 25-Pin Port
RS-422A
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

11
25-pin Wiring Diagram 13 Term.
25 = do not use 15-pin

12 13 = CTS–
12 = CTS+
D-sub
(male) 24 = do not use TXD+ 14
23 = do not use
15
9 RD+
10
8 = do not use
RD– 7 = do not use
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
11 = RTS– 25 22 = do not use TXD– 15
10 = RTS+ 21 = do not use RXD+ 17 11 SD+ 6 = do not use 13 = Termination
13 9 = do not use
8 = do not use
7=0V
20 = do not use
19 = do not use RXD–
16
7
5 = Logic GND
12 SD– 4 = do not use
5 3 = do not use
12 = SD– (RS422)
11 = SD+ (RS422)
10 = RD– (RS422)
18 = do not use 0V
6 = do not use 2 = do not use 1 9 = RD+ (RS422)
17 = RXD+
14 5 = do not use
4 = do not use
3 = do not use 16 =
(RS422)
RXD–
RTS–
CTS–
11
13
1 = Frame GND

2 = do not use (RS422)


RTS+ 10 * Note: The DCM modules must be set for:
A 1 = do not use 1 15 = TXD–
(RS422)
14 = TXD+
CTS+ 12
shield 1
Direct NET Slave, HEX mode.

(RS422)

B Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.

C NOTE: The RS-422 wiring diagrams shown above are not for multi-drop networks involving connecting more
than one PLC to a panel. Refer to the wiring diagram example on page 6-38 if more than one PLC will be
connected to a panel.
D

6–34 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1
Diagram 7 User Constructed
To PLC
9-Pin Port
Omron FINS (CQM1, CPM1, CPM2, C200, CJ1 & CS1)
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
2
RS-232C with DC Power Adapter

3
9-pin
D-sub
(male) Wiring Diagram
15-pin
D-sub
8 = do not use (male)
7 = do not use
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
4
1 = do not use 9 2 3 6 = do not use 13 = do not use
6 = do not use TXD 15
2 = TXD
3 = RXD
4 = RTS
7 = do not use
8 = do not use RXD
3
9
2
5
RXD
TXD
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
5
9 = Signal GND SG 10 = do not use
5 = CTS 1 2 = TXD (232C) 9 = do not use
RTS
CTS
4
5
1 = Frame GND 1
6
shield 1

Diagram 8
N t U th b ii di t k bl W d i 22 AWG hi ld d
User Constructed
bl 7
To Peripheral
Port Cable
Omron Host Link CQM1 using
CQM1-CIF02 Peripheral Port Connecting Cable
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter
8
RS-232C
9
9-pin 15-pin
D-sub
(male) Wiring Diagram 8 = do not use
7 = do not use
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
10
1 = do not use 9 3 3 6 = do not use 13 = do not use
6 = do not use TXD RXD 15
2 = RXD
3 = TXD
4 = do not use
7 = do not use
8 = do not use RXD
2
5
2
5
TXD
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
11
9 = do not use GND
5 = Signal GND 1 2 = TXD (232C) 9 = do not use
shield 1 1 = Frame GND 1
Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–35
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Diagram 9 User Constructed
2 To PLC
9-Pin Port
Modicon™ ModBus™, 984 CPU, Quanum 113 CPU
RS-232C
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

3
9-pin 15-pin
4 D-sub
(male) Wiring Diagram
D-sub
8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
9
7 = do not use 14 = do not use
1 = do not use 6 = DSR 3 3 6 = do not use 15 13 = do not use
5 2 = RXD
3 = TXD
4 = DTR
7 = RTS
8 = CTS
TXD
RXD 2
5
2
5
RXD
TXD
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
9 = do not use GND 3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
5 = Signal GND 1 2 = TXD (232C) 1
6 DTR
DSR
4
6
1 = Frame GND
9 = do not use

RTS 7

7 CTS 8
shield 1

8 Diagram 10 User Constructed


AEG Modicon™ Micro Series: To C-more Micro-Graphic
9 To PLC
9-Pin Port 110 CPU 311-xx, 110 CPU 411-xx, 110 CPU 512-xx, 110 CPU 612-xx
RS-232C
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

10 9-pin 15-pin
D-sub D-sub
11 (female)
1 = do not use 1 6 = do not use TXD 2
Wiring Diagram

3 RXD
8 = do not use (male)
7 = do not use
6 = do not use 15
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
13 = do not use
2 = TXD 7 = do not use 5 = Logic GND 12 = do not use
3 2
12 3 = RXD
4 = do not use
5 = Signal GND 9
8 = do not use
9 = do not use
RXD
GND 5 5
TXD 4 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
2 = TXD (232C)
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
shield 1 1 = Frame GND 1

13 Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

14
A
B
C
D

6–36 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


Diagram 11 User Constructed
1
To PLC
Modicon™ ModBus™ with RJ45 To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
2
RJ45 Port RS-232C with DC Power Adapter

3
1 = do not use
RJ45 8-pin
Phone Plug
(8P8C) TXD 3
Wiring Diagram
3 RXD
15-pin
D-sub
4
2 = do not use 8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
4 2
3 = TXD
4 = RXD
5 = Logic GND
RXD
GND 5
6
5
TXD 7 = do not use
6 = donot use
5 = Logic GND
15 14 = do not use
13 = do not use
12 = do not use
5
6 = RTS RTS 4 = do not use 11 = do not use
7 = CTS
8 = do not use
CTS 7

1
3 = RXD (232C)
2 = TXD (232C) 1
1 = Frame GND
10 = do not use
9 = do not use 6
shield
Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.
7
Diagram 12 User Constructed 8
To C-more Micro-Graphic
GE VersaMax Micro Port 1 EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
To PLC
RJ45 Port 1
RS-232C with DC Power Adapter
9
RJ45 8-pin 15-pin
10
Phone Plug Wiring Diagram D-sub
1 = RTS (8P8C)
2 = CTS
3 = RXD
4 = TXD
TXD
RXD
4
3
3
2
8 = do not use
RXD 7 = do not use
TXD 6 = donot use
(male) 15 = do not use
15 14 = do not use
13 = do not use
11
5 = DCD 8 5 5 = Logic GND 12 = do not use
6 = DTR
7 = +5V
8 = GND
GND
shield 1
4 = do not use
3 = RXD (232C)
2 = TXD (232C) 1
11 = do not use
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
12
1 = Frame GND
Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable. 13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–37
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


1 Diagram 13 User Constructed
2 To PLC
9-Pin Port
Siemens S7-200 CPU Port 0 or 1
RS-485A
To C-more Micro-Graphic
EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port
with DC Power Adapter

3
4 9-pin
D-sub RS-485 3
Wiring Diagram 13
9
Term.
RD+
15-pin
D-sub
(male) Signal B 8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
1 11 SD+ 7 = do not use 14 = do not use
5 1 = Logic Com
2 = Logic Com
3 = RS485 Sig B
6 = +5 VDC
7 = +24 VDC
8 = RS485 Sig A
RS-485
Signal A
8 10
12
RD–
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
15
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS485)
4 = do not use SD– 4 = do not use 11 = SD+ (RS485)
9 = do not use 3 = do not use
6 5 = Logic Com 9 Logic
Common
5
shield
5

1
2 = do not use 1
1 = Frame GND
10 = RD– (RS485)
9 = RD+ (RS485)

Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend Belden 9842 shielded cable or equivalent.
7 Diagram 14 User Constructed
8 To PLC
9-Pin Port
Mitsubishi Q / QnA Serial PLC
QJ71C24N
To C-more Micro-Graphic
Serial Port2

RS-232C
9 Wiring Diagram

10 9-pin
D-sub
CD
DTR
1
4 15-pin
D-sub
(female) DSR 6 8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
11 1 = CD
2 = RXD
1
6 = DSR
7 = RS
RS 7
8
7 = do not use
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
15
14 = do not use
13 = do not use
12 = do not use
3 = TXD CS
8 = CS 3 4 = do not use 11 = do not use
12 4 = DTR
5 = Signal GND 9
9 = do not use TXD
RXD 2
3
2
RXD
3 = RXD (232C)
TXD 2 = TXD (232C)
1
10 = do not use
9 = do not use
5 5 1 = Frame GND
GND

13 shield 1

Note: Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.

14
A
B
C
D

6–38 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

User Constructed Cables – Wiring Diagrams (cont’d)


Diagram 15 User Constructed
1
Mitsubishi Q02 / Q02H / Q06H / Q12H / Q25H Serial Driver
and QnA Serial Driver with Direct Connection to To C-more Micro-Graphic
2
Serial Port2
To PLC the Serial Port on Q00 and Q01 CPU’s
6-Pin Port
RS-232C 3
1 = RXD (232C)
Mini Din
6-pin Male Wiring Diagram 8 = do not use
15-pin
D-sub
(male) 15 = do not use
4
2 = TXD (232C) 7 = do not use 15 14 = do not use
2 3
3 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
5 = do not use
5 6
TXD
RXD 1 2
RXD 6 = donot use
TXD 5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
13 = do not use
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
5
3 4 GND 3 5
3 = RXD (232C) 10 = do not use
6 = do not use
1 2
shield 1 2 = TXD (232C)
1 = Frame GND
1 9 = do not use

Note: Use the above wiring diagram to make your own cable. We recommend using 22 AWG shielded cable.
6
7
Diagram 16 User Constructed 8
To PLC Allen Bradley PLC5 DF1 To C-more Micro-Graphic EA-MG-SP1
25-Pin Port
RS-422 Serial Port with Power Adapter
9
25-pin Wiring Diagram 15-pin
10
D-sub D-sub
13 = do not use (male) 25 = do not use TXD + 2
12 = do not use
11 = do not use
25 24 = do not use
23 = do not use RXD +
3
10 RD – 8 = do not use
12 SD – 7 = do not use
(male) 15 = do not use
14 = do not use
15 13 = do not use
11
10 = do not use 6 = do not use
22 = do not use GND 7 5
5 = Logic GND 12 = SD –
9 = do not use
8 = do not use
7 = Signal GND
21 = do not use
20 = do not use
TXD – 14
19 = do not use RXD – 16
9 RD + 4 = do not use
11 SD + 3 = do not use
11 = SD +
10 = RD –
12
6 = do not use 2 = do not use 1 9 = RD +
5 = do not use 18 = do not use
4 = do not use
3 = RXD +
2 = TXD +
17 = do not use
16 = RXD –
shield 1
1 = Frame GND
13
1 15 = do not use
1 = do not use 14 = TXD –
Notes:
1. Polarities must be swapped.
14
2. Handshaking is turned off
3. Use the above wiring diagram if you need to make your own cable. We recommend using 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.
4. Refer to the PLC-5 Programmable Controllers User Manual Switch Setting Reference for details on switch settings to define
the controller's serial port electrical interface. A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–39
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples


1
2 DirectLOGIC
DirectLOGIC
DL205 PLC
DL06 PLC
3
4 Port 2
(Slave)

5
6 Port 2 (Slave)
Shielded Cable

7 Shielded Cable

8
9
10 Note: We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.

11 To DL06 PLC port 2 To D2-250-1 PLC port 2


RXD+

RXD+
RXD–

RXD–
TXD+

TXD+
RTS+

CTS+

RTS+

CTS+
TXD–

RTS–
CTS–

TXD–

RTS–

CTS–
GND

GND

12 7 10 9 6
*
13 11 14 12 15 7 10 9 6 13 11 14 12 15

13 15-pin
HD D-sub
8 = do not use (male) 15 = CTS–
7 = Sig GND 14 = CTS+
6 = RXD– 15 13 = RXD+

14 5 = do not use
4 = do not use
3 = do not use 1
2 = do not use 6
12 = RTS-
11 = RTS+
10 = TXD–
9 = TXD+
1 = do not use

A RXD+
HD = High Density

RXD+

RXD– RXD–

B TXD+

TXD–
TXD+

TXD–

C Signal GND

* Termination resistors required at both ends of the


shield
Signal GND

network receive data signals to match the impedance

D of the cable (between 100 and 500 ohms).


Typical RS-422 Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram

6–40 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples (cont’d)


1
Serial Port w/

DirectLOGIC
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1 2
DL06 PLC
3
4
(Master)

(Slave)
C-more 3”
Micro-Graphic
5
Panel
Port 2 Shielded Cable 6
Shielded Cable
7
8
9
Note: We recommend Belden 8103 shielded cable or equivalent.
To C-more 3” Micro-Graphic
10
Serial Port w/ DC Power Adapter,
To DL06 PLC port 2 p/n EA-MG-SP1
11

* Term.
RXD+
RXD–
TXD+

RTS+

CTS+
TXD–

RTS–
CTS–

SHD
RD+
RD–

SD+
GND

SD–
GND

7 10 9 6 13 11 14 12 15 5 10 9 12 11 13 1 12
15-pin
HD D-sub
8 = do not use (male) 15 = CTS–
7 = Sig GND 14 = CTS+
15-pin
D-sub
8 = do not use (male) 15 = do not use
13
6 = RXD– 15 13 = RXD+ 7 = do not use 15 14 = do not use
5 = do not use
4 = do not use
3 = do not use 1
2 = do not use 6
12 = RTS-
11 = RTS+
10 = TXD–
9 = TXD+
6 = do not use
5 = Logic GND
4 = do not use
3 = do not use
13 = Termination
12 = SD– (RS422)
11 = SD+ (RS422)
14
10 = RD– (RS422)
1 = do not use 2 = do not use 1
9 = RD+ (RS422)
HD = High Density

RXD+
1 = Frame GND

RXD+
A
RXD– RXD–

TXD+

TXD–
TXD+

TXD–
B
Signal GND
shield
Signal GND
shield
* Termination resistors required at both ends of the
C
network receive data signals to match the impedance

Typical RS-422 Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram (cont’d)


of the cable (between 100 and 500 ohms). Jumper pin
13 to 9 on the C-more EA-MG-SP1 15-pin connector
to place the 120⏲ internal resistor into the network. If
the cable impedance is different, then use an external
D
resister matched to the cable impedance.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–41
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples (cont’d)


1
2 DirectLOGIC
DirectLOGIC
DL205 PLC
DL06 PLC
3
4 Port 2

5
6 Port 2
Shielded Cable

7 Shielded Cable

8
9
10 Note: We recommend Belden 88102 shielded cable or equivalent.

11
To DL06 PLC port 2 To D2-250-1 PLC port 2

12
RXD+

RXD+
RXD–

RXD–
TXD+

RTS+

CTS+

TXD+

RTS+

CTS+
TXD–

RTS–
CTS–

TXD–

RTS–

CTS–
GND

GND

7 6 10 13 9 11 14 12 15 7 6 10 13 9 11 14 12 15

13 *
15-pin
HD D-sub

14 8 = do not use (male) 15 = CTS–


7 = Sig GND
6 = RXD– 15
14 = CTS+
13 = RXD+
5 = do not use 12 = RTS-
4 = do not use 11 = RTS+
A 3 = do not use 1
2 = do not use
1 = do not use
6
10 = TXD–
9 = TXD+

HD = High Density

B TXD– / RXD–

TXD+ / RXD+
TXD– / RXD–

TXD+ / RXD+

C * Termination resistors required at both ends of


Signal GND
shield
Signal GND

the network to match the impedance of the cable

D (between 100 and 500 ohms).


Typical RS-485 Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram

6–42 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 6: PLC Communications

RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples (cont’d)


1
Serial Port w/

DirectLOGIC
DC Power Adapter
EA-MG-SP1 2
DL06 PLC
3
4
C-more 3”
Micro-Graphic
5
Panel
Port 2 Shielded Cable 6
Shielded Cable
7
8
9
Note: We recommend Belden 88102 shielded cable or equivalent. 10
To C-more 3” Micro-Graphic
Serial Port w/ DC Power Adapter,
11
To DL06 PLC port 2 p/n EA-MG-SP1

12

* Term.
RXD+
RXD–

TXD+

RTS+

CTS+
TXD–

RTS–
CTS–

SHD
RD+
RD–

SD+
GND

GND

7 6 10 13 9 11 14 12 15 5 10 12SD– 9 11 13 1

13
15-pin
HD D-sub
8 = do not use (male) 15 = CTS–
7 = Sig GND
6 = RXD– 15
14 = CTS+
13 = RXD+
15-pin
8 = do not use D-sub
7 = do not use (male)
15
15 = do not use
14 = do not use
14
5 = do not use 12 = RTS- 6 = do not use 13 = Termination
5 = Logic GND 12 = SD– (RS485)
4 = do not use
3 = do not use 1
2 = do not use
1 = do not use
6
11 = RTS+
10 = TXD–
9 = TXD+
4 = do not use
3 = do not use
2 = do not use 1
11 = SD+ (RS485)
10 = RD– (RS485)
9 = RD+ (RS485)
A
HD = High Density 1 = Frame GND

TXD– / RXD–

TXD+ / RXD+
TXD– / RXD–

TXD+ / RXD+
B
Signal GND
shield
Signal GND
shield

* Termination resistors required at both ends of the


C
network receive data signals to match the impedance

Typical RS-485 Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram (cont’d)


of the cable (between 100 and 500 ohms). Jumper pin
13 to 9 on the C-more EA-MG-SP1 15-pin connector
to place the 120⏲ internal resistor into the network. If
D
the cable impedance is different, then use an external
resister matched to the cable impedance.

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 6–43
CHAPTER
MAINTENANCE
7
In This Chapter...
Project Backup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–2
Check Operating Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–2
Check Operating Voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–2
Check Transmit and Receive Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–3
Check Physical Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–3
Run Tests under the System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–4
Check Settings under the System Setup Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–5
Cleaning the Display Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–5
Check Project Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–6
Checks from the C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7–6
Chapter 7: Maintenance

Maintenance
1 Although the C-more® Micro-Graphic panels require very little maintenance, setting up a
routine maintenance schedule will insure the longevity of the product in your application.
2 The following are some suggestions of items to include in a preventive maintenance list or
schedule. Most of these items should be scheduled quarterly or bi-annually.
3
Project Backup
4 During a routine preventive maintenance check is a good time to make sure that there is an up-
to-date backup of the application project. Although the C-more Micro-Graphic panel with its
5 programming software has the ability to upload the complete project from a panel, insurance is
warranted just in case the worse case scenario happens and the entire panel is destroyed.

6 Check Operating Environment


7 Make sure the Micro-Graphic panel is
operating in the proper temperature
range: (0 to 50 °C (32 to 122 °F)).
8
Make sure the Micro-Graphic panel is
9 operating within the specified humidity range:
(5–95% RH, non-condensing).
10
Make sure the operating environment is free of corrosive gasses. CORROSIVE

11 8

12 Check Operating Voltage


Check the input voltage that is powering the Micro-Graphic panel to make sure it is within the
appropriate range.
13 5 VDC: If the panel is being powered with 5 VDC from an AutomationDirect PLC’s
RJ12 serial communications port to Port 1 on the panel, the acceptable voltage
14 range to the panel is 4.75-5.25 VDC (1.05 W @ 5 VDC (210 mA)).
24 VDC: If the panel is being powered from the optional EA-MG-P1 DC Power
A Adapter, or the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, the
acceptable voltage range to the adapter is 10.8-26.4 VDC (100 mA @ 24
VDC).
B
C
D

7–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 7: Maintenance

Check Transmit and Receive Indicators


During a routine maintenance check is a good time to take a quick look at the status indicators
on the back of the C-more Micro-Graphic panel, and the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port w/ DC 1
Power Adapter, if being used. There should be activity on both the TxD and RxD LED
indicators when connected serially to a PLC or control device from either port. 2
TxD
Indicator Micro-Graphic Panel
Port 1 Status Indicators
3
RxD
Indicator
4
5
6
TxD
Indicator
RxD
Indicator
7
EA-MG-SP1 8
Port 2 Status Indicators
Port 2 9
10
11
12
Check Physical Conditions
Make sure that harmful chemicals are not being used around the C-more Micro-Graphic panel.
Look for any deterioration of the panel’s bezel and front display area. See Chapter 2:
13
Specifications for a chemical compatibility list.
Check the mounting gasket to make sure it is sealing properly and has not deteriorated. Replace
14
the mounting gasket if there are any signs of deterioration, or if there is any evidence that
moisture/liquids have penetrated to the inside of the enclosure where the panel is mounted. A
Information on replacement gaskets can be found in Chapter 9: Replacement Parts.
Check to make sure that none of the cooling vents around the inside section of the Micro- B
Graphic panel are clogged with dust or debris. Also make sure that there is clearance around the
panel as shown in Chapter 4: Installation and Wiring. C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 7–3
Chapter 7: Maintenance

Run Tests under the System Setup Screens


Use the C-more Micro-Graphic panel’s System Setup Screens to test communication ports, PLC
1 connectivity, and the internal beeper. See Chapter 5: System Setup Screens for additional
details. Below is shown the Test Menu. Please note the Serial Port2 selection will only be seen
2 when the EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power Adapter option is installed on the panel.

3 TEST MENU
1.Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test
2.Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test
4 3.PLC Enquiry Test
4.Buzzer Test
BAK -- UP DWN ENT

5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

6 Serial Port 1 - Performs a test to verify the RJ12 serial communications port (Port 1) on the
panel is operating correctly. Requires a loop back connector inserted into the port to properly
7 run the test. A wiring diagram for the loop back connector is shown below.
Serial Port 2 - Performs a test to verify either the RS-232 or the RS485/422 serial
8 communications functionality from the 15-pin connector (Port 2) on the EA-MG-SP1 Serial
Port with DC Power Adapter is operating correctly. Requires a loop back connector inserted
into the port to properly run the test. A wiring diagram for either a RS-232 or RS-485/422 loop
9 back connector is shown below.

10 RJ12 Loop-back Connector


RJ12 6-pin
Phone Plug Jumper
Pin 3 to 4
RS-232 Loop-back Connector
15-pin D-sub
(male)
RS-422/485 Loop-back Connector
7 CTS 15-pin D-sub
8 RTS
(male)
(6P6C) 2 TXD 15 9 15

11 3
4
RXD
3
7
RXD
CTS
11
10
RXD+
TXD+
RXD–
TXD 8 RTS
123456 1 12 TXD– 1

12 Wiring Diagram Wiring Diagram Wiring Diagram

PLC Enquiry Test - Tests the communications with the selected PLC protocol between the
13 panel and a connected PLC. Is used with both Port 1 and Port 2.
Buzzer Test - Use this option to test the internal audible beeper of the panel.
14
A
NOTE: The panel has one built-in RJ12 serial communications port (Port 1 - RS-232) and the option to add
B one 15-pin serial communications port (Port 2 - RS-232/422/485) to the panel by installing the EA-MG-SP1
module. Only one of the ports can be used with a connected PLC. The programming software allows the user
C to select either Comm. Port1 or Comm. Port2 under the Panel Manager dialog box. When using Port 2 to
communicate with the connected PLC, Port 1 can still be used with the EA-MG-PGM-CBL Software
Programming Cable Assembly to transfer projects between the PC and panel.
D

7–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 7: Maintenance

Check Settings under the System Setup Screens


Use the C-more Micro-Graphic panel’s System Setup Screens to check the various settings such
as the LCD contrast, background color, beep, etc. See Chapter 5: System Setup Screens for 1
additional details. Below is shown the Setting Menu. Note the use of the up/down keys to access
the last item. 2
SETTING
1.LCD Contrast >
SETTING
6.Reset Factory Default
3
2.Backlight >
3.Beep
4.Calibration
5.Clear User Memory
>
4
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT BAK NXT UP DWN ENT

F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
5
LCD Contrast - Used to adjust the LCD display’s contrast. The default is a value of 3, and the 6
range is 1 to 5, with 5 being the highest contrast.
Backlight - There are five different available backlight colors. Use this option to select the 7
default screen color and also cycle through the colors for checking.
8
Cleaning the Display Screen
The display screen should be cleaned periodically by wiping it with a lint free damp cloth using 9
a mild soap solution. Dry the surface when finished with a lint free cloth. Do not clean with
ammonia based products. The ABS material the bezel is made from is reactive with ammonia. 10
The longevity of the display screen on the touch screen models can be increased by the use of a
EA-MG-COV-CL clear screen overlay. See Chapter 3: Accessories for additional information
on the screen overlay.
11
To prevent damage to the display screen on the touch screen models, avoid touching the screen
with sharp objects, striking the screen with a hard object, using abrasives near the screen, or
12
using excessive force when pressing the touch screen version.
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 7–5
Chapter 7: Maintenance

Check Project Functionality


During a routine maintenance check is a good time to verify the functionality of your
1 application, making sure that various areas on different screens do what they were designed to
do. An outline or specification for the application is a useful tool for testing the various aspects
2 of your application. As a starting point, you may want to run through all the screens to make
sure they are accessible.
3 If there are any trouble-shooting procedures built into the Micro-Graphic panel application,
now is a good time to also check these aids.
4
Checks from the C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software
5 If you have a PC available with the C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software,
EA-MG-PGMSW, installed, and the PC is connected to the panel, you can check the status of
the panel by using the Panel Information window.
6 The Panel Information window shown below will indicate the panel type, any options such as
a keypad bezel or DC power adapter that have been installed, the total memory, memory used,
7 free memory, firmware version, mask ROM version, and the PLC protocol the panel has been
setup for using on its serial communication port. The programming software can also be used
8 to update the panel’s firmware to the latest version.

9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

7–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 7: Maintenance

Notes:
_____________________________________________________________ 1
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
2
_____________________________________________________________ 3
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 4
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 5
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 6
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 7
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 8
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 9
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
10
_____________________________________________________________ 11
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 12
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 13
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ 14
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ A
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ B
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________ C
_____________________________________________________________
_____________________________________________________________
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 7–7
CHAPTER
TROUBLESHOOTING
8
In This Chapter...
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel does not Power up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–2
Display is Blank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–2
Display is Dim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–3
No User Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–3
Lost Firmware – Red ‘Update Mode’ Screen Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–4
No Communications between Panel and PC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–5
No Communications between Panel and PLC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–7
Panel & PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–8
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Runtime Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–9
Electrical Noise Problems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8–10
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
1 The following are some common problems that may be encountered during the installation
and operation of your C-more® Micro-Graphic panel. We have made some suggestions on
2 what to check in order to correct the problem.

3 C-more Micro-Graphic Panel does not Power up


Powered from 5 VDC: If the panel’s display is blank, not responding, and the panel is powered
4 from a 5 VDC power source, check the incoming DC voltage level with a voltmeter. The DC
voltage level should be in the range of 4.75 to 5.25 VDC. If the incoming DC voltage is zero,
check any fusing that may be in the circuit. If the fuse is open, determine cause and replace.
5 Powered from 12-24 VDC: If the panel’s display is blank, not responding, and the panel is
powered from one of the optional DC Power Adapter modules, such as an EA-MG-P1 or EA-
6 MG-SP1, check the incoming DC voltage level to the adapter with a voltmeter. The DC voltage
level to the adapter should be in the range of 10.8-26.4 VDC. If the incoming DC voltage is
7 zero, check any fusing that may be in the circuit. If the fuse is open, determine cause and
replace.

8
Display is Blank
9 Also if the panel’s display is blank, check the TxD and RxD indicators on the back side of the
panel while the panel is communicating with the PLC. The LED indicators should be on or
flashing at a fast rate. Indicator activity shows that the panel is communicating with the PLC.
10 If there is communication activity, but the display is still blank, there is the possibility the
program in the PLC is controlling the display. Try pressing the F1 and F5 keys simultaneously
11 for 3 seconds. The panel should display the System Setup Screen menu if the screen is being
forced to display a blank by the PLC program, or check the PLC program, it may have the
screen in the off state by placing a 0 in the current screen tag.
12
TxD
13 Indicator

14 RxD
Indicator
A
B
C
D

8–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Display is Dim
Press the F1 and F5 keys simultaneously for 3 seconds to access the System Setup Screen menu.
Select the Setting menu, and then select item 1, LCD Contrast. The default value is 3. Adjust 1
the current value from 1 to 5 and the panel's contrast should become greater as the value moves
toward 5 and it should become less as the value moves toward 1. If this does not happen, then
the panel may need to be replaced.
2
SETTING LCD CONTRAST
3
1.LCD Contrast
2. Backlight
3.Beep
4.Calibration
>
>
>
Current Value: 3
4
5.Clear User Memory
BAK NXT UP DWN ENT BAK -- UP DWN APL
5
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

6
No User Program 7
If the panel is displaying the message "No User Program" after it is powered up, then there is
no project downloaded into the panel. Using the EA-MG-PGMSW C-more Micro-Graphic 8
Programming Software, download your project to the panel.
9
SETUP MENU
1.Information >
10
2.Setting
NO USER PROGRAM >
3.Test Menu
4.Exit
BAK – UP DWN ENT
>
11
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 8–3
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Lost Firmware – Red ‘Update Mode’ Screen Displayed


If the C-more Micro-Graphic panel’s firmware becomes corrupted or for some reason is lost
1 from the panel’s memory, the panel will display the Update Mode screen as shown below. This
can happen if communication between the PC and the panel is interrupted during a firmware
2 update from the programming software. To resolve the problem, try the following steps in the
order shown:
3 1.) Cycle power to the panel.
2.) Attempt to reload the firmware to the panel using the Update Firmware utility under the
4 Panel pull down menu in the EA-MG-PGMSW Programming Software.
3.) If the firmware update is not successful, depress function keys F1 and F5 while cycling
5 power to the panel. The panel should come up in the red Update Mode screen as shown
below. Perform Step 2 again.
4.) Call Tech Support @ 770-844-4200.
6
7 = Update Mode =
Port1 [ 6pin]
115.2K/8/0/1

8 Port2 [15pin]
115.2K/8/0/1
Data Change Push Key1

9 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

8–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

No Communications between Panel and PC (Personal Computer)


The C-more Micro-Graphic panel is programmed using the C-more Micro-Graphic
Programming Software, EA-MG-PGMSW. The developed project is transferred from the PC to 1
the panel by a USB to RS-232 serial communications cable. The EA-MG-PGM-CBL Serial
Programming Cable Assembly can be used to accomplish the interface between the PC and
panel. Installing the programming software also installs a USB driver on the PC. When
2
properly installed the programming cable will look like a serial communications port to the PC.
3
USB to RS-232 Programming Cable Assembly
4
PC to Panel Programming
Cable Assembly
(Includes serial & USB cables)
5
p/n EA-MG-PGM-CBL

6
User PC
7
USB
Serial
Cable
8
Cable

9
USB to RS232
Converter 10
C-more
Micro-Graphic
Panel 11
NOTE: The panel has one built-in RJ12 serial communications port (Port 1 - RS-232) and the option to add
one 15-pin serial communications port (Port 2 - RS-232/422/485) to the panel by installing the EA-MG-SP1
12
module. Only one of the ports can be used with a connected PLC. The programming software allows the user
to select either Comm. Port1 or Comm. Port2 under the Panel Manager dialog box. When using Port 2 to 13
communicate with the connected PLC, Port 1 can still be used with the EA-MG-PGM-CBL Software
Programming Cable Assembly to transfer projects between the PC and panel.
14
NOTE: If either DC power adapter is installed on the panel, the adapter must be powered and the panel not
A
dependent on +5 VDC from the PLC’s RJ12 comm port.
B
No communications between panel and PC continued top of next page. C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 8–5
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

No Communications between Panel and PC (Personal Computer) (cont’d)


There are three possible causes that prevent transferring the project to the C-more Micro-
1 Graphic panel.

2
3
4
1. Panel not on setup screen (press F1 and F5) - Press and hold the F1 and F5 buttons
5 simultaneously for three seconds to enter the setup screen.
2. Cable not connected - Double check the programming cable asembly to make sure the panel is
6 correctly connected to the USB port on the PC.
3. Not using the correct com port assigned to the USB adapter - If the C-more Micro-Graphic panel
is on the setup screen and the cable connection is
7 correct, then check the PC COM port setting. If
you are unsure which COM port the C-more
8 Micro-Gaphic programming cable is connected
to, click on the Device Manager button. This will
open Windows ® Device Manager.
9
In the Device Manager window, view the active
10 avaiable ports by clicking the + button beside the
Ports (COM & LPT) menu item. The C-more
Micro-Graphic panel uses a USB driver called
11 Koyo USB-Serial Comm Port. COM4 is the
comm port used in this example. If you cannot

12 find the Koyo USB-Serial Comm Port under the


Ports (COM & LBT) menu item in Device
13 Manager, the USB driver may not be correctly
installed or the driver has a problem. See the
software installation manual for details on installing
14 the Koyo USB-Serial Comm Port driver. If you have
selected the correct COM port and the error still
occurs, try connecting the programming cable to a
A different USB port on the PC and try again.
If the program persists, call Technical Support at
B (770) 844-4200, available from 9:00 A.M. to 6:00
P.M. Eastern Time.

C
D

8–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

No Communications between Panel and PLC


The communications between the C-more Micro-Graphic panel and a designated PLC or
controlling device can be accomplished using the panel’s built-in RS-232 RJ12 serial 1
communications port (Port 1) or by installing a EA-MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power
Adapter module (Port 2) to the rear of the panel. The EA-MG-SP1 includes a 15-pin connector
that can be connected for RS-232, RS-485 or RS-422.
2
TxD
3
Port 1: If you are using Port 1 then Indicator
check the Txd and Rxd status
indicators on the back side of the
4
panel. They should be on or flashing RxD
at a fast rate. If there is activity on the
Indicator
5
LED indicators, then the panel and
PLC are communicating. Location of
Port 1’s LED status indicators shown
6
to the right.
7
TxD RxD
Port 2: If you are using Port 2 then
check the Txd and Rxd status
Indicator Indicator
8
indicators on the back side of the EA-
MG-SP1 Serial Port with DC Power 9
Adapter. They should be on or
Port 2
flashing at a fast rate. If there is
activity on the LED indicators, then
10
the panel and PLC are
communicating. Location of Port 2’s 11
LED status indicators shown to the
right. 12
On either serial communications port, if there is no activity on one or both TxD and RxD LED
status indicators, then:
13
• Verify that the communication settings are correct in the panel manager
• Test or replace the cable.
14
• Test the panel or adapter’s serial port (Page 5-14 & 5-15).
• Test the serial port on the PLC. A
Electrical noise, pulse generating wiring and/or improper grounding can also cause problems
with communications. Refer to the Electrical Noise Problems section in this chapter for
additional help if electrical noise is suspected.
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 8–7
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Panel & PLC Error Codes


The C-more Micro-Graphic panel includes built-in PLC communication protocol diagnostics
1 that monitor the exchange of data between the panel and the PLC. The diagnostics look for the
proper exchange of data, correct handshaking signals, addressing errors, incorrect data bytes,
2 wrong packet format, etc. The diagnostics also monitor and display any of the errors that the
designated PLC would normally generate if there is a problem with the PLC’s communications.
The PLC generated errors are interpreted by the C-more Micro-Graphic programming software
3 and are displayed across the top of the panel’s display embedded as a hexadecimal value in error
code P499.
4 If a C-more Micro-Graphic communications error does occur, the error message will be
displayed in the upper left of the panel’s display screen along with the error code number. The
5 error code with error message will blink off and on. A detailed list and description of the various
PLC protocol errors can be found in Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables.
6
Panel Error Code Table Example:
7 C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Table
Error Code Error Message Cause
8 P001 PLC Com Time Out A timeout occurred after sending a request to the PLC.

9 P499 ErrCode Received -> A PLC generated error code with a hexadecimal value of XXXX has been
Recv .Err Code XXXX returned from the PLC.

10
PLC Error Code Table Example:
11 PLC Error Codes for Direct LOGIC – ModBus (Koyo)
12 Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description
0x1 The function code is unknown by the server.
13
0x4 The server failed during the execution.
14
Note: See Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables for a complete list of all error codes.
A
Panel Communications
B Error Code Example
P001: PLC COM Time Out

C Start Stop

D F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

8–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Runtime Errors


The C-more Micro-Graphic panel includes built-in diagnostics that check for proper operation
of the panel when it is running a project that has been transferred to its memory. Faults detected 1
while the panel is running will produce a “Runtime” error. These errors are displayed in a
popup window in the center of the panel’s display. 2
Troubleshooting a Panel Runtime Error: 3
Follow these steps to troubleshoot a panel runtime error.
1. Check the panel cable connections. 4
2. Cycle power at the panel.
3. Resend the project. 5
4. If the error still occurs, reset the panel back to factory default. Refer to Chapter 5 for details

NOTE: User memory is cleared when factory defaults are reset. Use the C-more Micro-Graphic
6
programming software to read the program from the panel and save a backup copy.
7
Panel Errors
If more than one panel error occurs, each error message will display sequentially for three 8
seconds with a two second delay between each message.
When only one panel error is active, that message will display continuously until it is no longer
active.
9
Micro-Graphic Panel Errors
10
Error Code Error Message Possible Solutions
R001 PC software tool Timeout Check cables and connections.
Cycle power at the panel.
11
See Chapter 8 for Electrical Noise Problems.
R002 CRC Error occurred during
project transfer from PC.
Check the area for sources of noise: electrical motors, transformers, etc.
Check for proper grounding
12
Resend the project.
R003 Project Check Sum Error.
Resend Project file to Panel.
Cycle power.
13
Protocol Module Check Sum Resend the project.
R004 Error. Resend Project File to
Panel 14
Panel Check Sum Error. Panel
R005 Info (Not Project) will be
initialized.
From the Setup Menu screen, reset panel options.
A
R006 SW Ver. Mismatch. Use Update to current version programming software and panel firmware.
software Ver.xx.xx.
Option module detected EA-MG-SP1 or EA-MG-P1 optional power adapter module is installed B
R100 without external power on a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel without a 12-24 VDC power
source. Provide 12-24 VDC power to the optional module.

R101
EA-MG-SP1 or EA-MG-P1 optional power adapter module for a C-more
Unsupported module detected 3” Micro-Graphic panel is installed on a C-more 6” Micro-Graphic panel.
C
Remove the EA-MG-SP1 or EA-MG-P1.
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 8–9
Chapter 8: Troubleshooting

Electrical Noise Problems


Noise is one of the most difficult problems to diagnose. Electrical noise can enter a system in
1 many different ways which fall into one of two categories, conducted or radiated. It may be
difficult to determine how the noise is entering the system but the corrective actions for either
2 of the types of noise problems are similar.
• Conducted noise is when the electrical interference is introduced into the system by way of an
3 attached wire, panel connection, etc. It may enter through a power supply connection, the
communication ground connection, or the chassis ground connection.
• Radiated noise is when the electrical interference is introduced into the system without a direct
4 electrical connection, much in the same manner as radio waves.
While electrical noise cannot be eliminated, it can be reduced to a level that will not affect the
5 system.
• Most noise problems result from improper grounding of the system. A good earth ground can be the
6 single most effective way to correct noise problems. If a ground is not available, install a ground rod
as close to the system as possible. Ensure all ground wires are single point grounds and are not daisy
chained from one device to another. Ground metal enclosures around the system. A loose wire can act
7 as a large antenna, introducing noise into the system. Therefore, tighten all connections in your
system. Loose ground wires are more susceptible to noise than the other wires in your system. Review
Chapter 4: Installation & Wiring if you have questions regarding how to ground the touch panel.
8 • Electrical noise can enter the system through the power source for the C-more Micro-Graphic panel.
Installing a properly wired isolation transformer (neutral grounded) for all AC sources can help the
9 problem, but only if wired correctly. DC sources should be well-grounded good quality supplies.
• Never run communication cables or low-voltage power wiring close to high voltage wiring or pulse
10 generating wiring that controls such devices as solenoids, servos, VFOs, etc.
Selecting a lower communication rate in Panel Manager may help the panel resist noise.
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

8–10 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
CHAPTER
REPLACEMENT PARTS
9
In This Chapter...
Replacement Parts Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
Panel Mounting Clips – EA-MG-S3ML-BRK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
Panel Gasket – EA-MG-S3ML-GSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
8-Button Keypad Bezel Mounting Clips – EA-MG-BZ1-BRK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
8-Button Keypad Bezel Gasket – EA-MG-BZ1-GSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–2
20-Button Keypad Bezel Mounting Clips – EA-MG-BZ2-BRK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
20-Button Keypad Bezel Gasket – EA-MG-BZ2-GSK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
DC Power Connector – EA-MG-DC-CON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
Function Keys Label Inserts – EA-MG-S3ML-FKL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–3
Customizing the Function Keys Label Insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9–4
Chapter 9: Replacement Parts

Replacement Parts Overview


1 Part Number Description Part Number Description
Replacement mounting clip for
2 EA-MG-S3ML-BRK C-more (pk of 2)
3” Micro-Graphic panels EA-MG-S3ML-GSK Replacement mounting gasket for
C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panels
Replacement mounting clip for Replacement mounting gasket for
3 EA-MG-BZ1-BRK C-more 3” Micro-Graphic keypad
bezel EA-MG-BZ1 (pk of 2)
EA-MG-BZ1-GSK C-more 3” Micro-Graphic keypad
bezel EA-MG-BZ1
Replacement mounting clip for Replacement mounting gasket for
4 EA-MG-BZ2-BRK C-more 3” Micro-Graphic keypad
bezel EA-MG-BZ2 (pk of 8)
EA-MG-BZ2-GSK C-more 3” Micro-Graphic keypad
bezel EA-MG-BZ2
Replacement adapter DC power
Replacement function key label
5 EA-MG-DC-CON connector for optional EA-MG-P1
and EA-MG-SP1 power adapters EA-MG-S3ML-FKL insert for C-more 3” Micro-
Graphic panels (pk of 10; 5 blank,
C-more
used with 3”Micro-
Graphic panels (pk of 5) 5 F1-F5)
6
7 Replacement Parts
8
Panel Mounting Clips Panel Gasket
9 Part No. EA-MG-S3ML-BRK Part No. EA-MG-S3ML-GSK

10
11
(pk of 2)
12
13 8-Button Keypad Bezel 8-Button Keypad Bezel
Mounting Clips Gasket
14 Part No. EA-MG-BZ1-BRK Part No. EA-MG-BZ1-GSK

A
B
C (pk of 2)
D

9–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Chapter 9: Replacement Parts

Replacement Parts (con’d)


20-Button Keypad Bezel 20-Button Keypad Bezel
1
Mounting Clips Gasket
Part No. EA-MG-BZ2-BRK Part No. EA-MG-BZ2-GSK
2
3
4
5
(pk of 8)
6
DC Power Connector Function Keys Label Inserts
Part No. EA-MG-DC-CON Part No. EA-MG-S3ML-FKL 7
8
9
(pk of 5)
(pk of 10; 5 blank, 5 F1-F5) 10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 9–3
Chapter 9: Replacement Parts

Customizing the Function Keys Insert Label


1 Step 1 - Remove existing Step 3 - If desired, print and
function key label insert apply self adhesive labels to
2 using a small tool such as
jeweler’s screw driver.
the blank insert.

3
4 Step 2 - Remove the
protective film from the
blank key label insert.
5
6
7 Step 4 - Install the new insert
into the slot in the side of the
8 panel and lock tab into place.

9
10
11
12 Label Printer Example: Brother P-touch model TZ-131, using TZ black print on
clear tape, p/n TZ-131, font: size 24 narrow, 10 spaces between each word.
13
14
4.035
A [102.5]

0.508
B [12.9]

0.254 0.581 Units: inches [mm]


C [6.5] [14.8]
Typical

D NOTE: Insert shown full size.

9–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
PANEL & PLC APPENDIX
ERROR CODE TABLES
A
In This Appendix...
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–2
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–3
Modbus Protocols Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
AutomationDirect CLICK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
AutomationDirect DirectLOGIC - Modbus (Koyo) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
Modicon Modbus RTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
Entivity Modbus RTU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–4
DirectLOGIC Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–5
DirectLOGIC – K-Sequence PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–5
DirectLOGIC – DirectNET PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–5
Allen-Bradley Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–6
Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–7
Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–9
GE Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–11
GE SNPX Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–12
Mitsubishi FX Protocol – PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–21
Mitsubishi Q / QnA and Q Series – PLC Error Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–21
Omron Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–23
Omron Host Link Protocol – PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–24
Omron FINS Protocol – PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–25
Siemens Error Code P499 Explanation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–28
Siemens PPI Protocol – PLC Error Code Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–29
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Introduction
A The C-more® Micro-Graphic panels are capable of communicating over RS232, RS422 and
RS485 serial networks. They communicate with CLICK PLC’s, all controllers in the Direct
2 LOGIC family of PLCs utilizing various protocols and certain 3rd party PLCs. For a complete
list of the supported PLCs and protocols, see the PLC Drivers table in Chapter 6: PLC
Communications.
3 As with any network communications, errors may occur. To simplify identification of the
possible cause of the error, we have provided tables listing these errors. If a C-more Micro-
4 Graphic panel communications error, or other related data exchange error does occur, the error
message will appear across the top of the display screen as shown in the example below. A
5 complete table of the panel generated errors, with their respective error codes, error messages,
and the possible causes of the error follows.
The C-more Micro-Graphic panel also monitors any errors that are generated by the PLC that
6 is connected to it. If any of the PLC generated errors are detected, they are displayed across the
top of the panel’s display embedded as a hexadecimal value in error code P499. An explanation
7 of how the specific PLC error is identified in the panel error code P499 is shown preceeding the
specific manufacturer’s PLC error tables. How the hexadecimal error code value is interpreted
is slightly different between manufacturers, so it is important to check the explanation at the
8 beginning of each manufacturer’s tables. Since these errors are generated by the PLC, refer to the
PLC manufacturers documentation for further explanation.
9 If you have difficulty determining the cause of the error, please refer to Chapter 8:
Troubleshooting for some troubleshooting tips or contact our technical support group at
10 770-844-4200.
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Example
11
P001: PLC COM Time Out

12
Start Stop

13
14 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

A
B
C
D

A–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Code Table


The following table includes all of the error codes and error messages that the panel will display A
if the listed cause is detected. All of these errors involve problems that could result with the
panel communicating with the connected PLC. Be aware that not all of the panel errors are used
with each type of PLC that can be connected to the panel.
2
Error Code Error Message
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Table
Cause
3
P001
P002
PLC Com Time Out
NAK Received
A timeout occurred after sending a request to the PLC.
A negative acknowledgement (NAK) control code has been generated during a read/write
4
request.
P003 EOT Received An end of transmission has been sent by PLC in response to a read/write/setbit request. 5
P004 STX is Not Found A Start of Text (STX) control code was not found in the data packet received from the PLC.
P005 ETX/ETB NotFound Neither an End of Text (ETX) nor an End of Transmission Block (ETB) control code was found in
the data packet received from the PLC.
6
There was an incorrect Longitudinal Redundancy Check (LRC) control code in the
P006 LRC Not Match communications packet received from the PLC. This is an indication that the data in the packet is
corrupted.
7
There was an incorrect Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) control code in the communications
P007
P008
CRC Not Match
Address NotMatch
packet received from the PLC. This is an indication that the data in the packet is corrupted.
The address value returned in the data packet from the PLC is incorrect.
8
P009 Re.INV.FUN.Code The function code returned in the data packet from the PLC is incorrect. 9
P010 DataSizeNotMatch There are an incorrect number of bytes found in the data packet returned from the PLC.
P011 INV.Val.FUN.Code There is an invalid value in the function code. 10
P012 INVALID COMMAND There was an invalid command sent to the PLC that wasn’t recognized by the PLC.
P013 ENQ Received If the data packet does not include a negative acknowledgement (NAK - 0x15 value) in the defined
packet field, then an enquiry (ENQ) control code error will be displayed.
11
P014 TransID NotMatch This error will be displayed if after checking the Transaction ID Byte in the data packet, there is

P015 Device Not Found


no match to what was requested.
A PLC device designated as Device could not be found.
12
P016
P017
DataByte Com.Err
Out of Add.Range
The data part of the packet received contains 0 bytes of data.
The touch panel requested a file number larger than 255.
13
P019 Parity Error Parity error occurred. 14
P021 PLC# Not Match PLC Number does not match
P023 Not Connected Cable not connected properly A
P024 No Other Dev. Cannot detect other devices
P025 PollingListErr. Panel not in polling list B
P028 No Response PLC failed to Respond: %PLC Node#%??
C
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Code Table continued on the next page.
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–3
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Code Table (cont’d)


A Error Code Error Message C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Table Cause
(cont’d)

2 P499* ErrCode Received -> A PLC generated error code with a hexadecimal value of XXXX has been returned from the
Recv .Err Code XXXX PLC. * See the explanation for error code P499 proceeding each set of PLC error code tables.
Data cannot be written to the Serial port.
P500 Can'tWriteS.Port Data was sent to the PLC via the Serial Port.
3 If this error shows on the Panel, it indicates a Hardware Problem.
P700 RD.Buff.MEM Full There was an error while allocating memory for the read buffer. When this error is displayed, a
memory leak may have occurred.
4 P701 INV.PLC Address Request to inaccessible memory from the HMI layer to the PLC protocol layer. This error is an
indication that there is a problem in the HMI layer.

5 P702 INV.FUN.Code A Read/Write/SetBit request has been sent to an invalid memory area. This error is an
indication that there is a problem in the HMI layer.
A PLC Write request was made to the PLC’s Read-Only memory area.This error is an indication
6 P703 WRT.PLC.ReadOnly that there is a problem in the HMI layer or the PLC protocol layer.

7 Modbus Protocols Error Code P499 Explanation


The following table lists the errors that can be generated by the Modbus protocols:

8 AutomationDirect CLICK
AutomationDirect DirectLOGIC - Modbus (Koyo)
9 Modicon Modbus RTU
Entivity Modbus RTU
10
Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
11 Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.

PLC Error Codes Modbus Protocols


12 Panel Error Name Meaning
Code
13 ILLEGAL
The function code received in the query is not an allowable action for the server (or slave). This
may be because the function code is only applicable to newer devices and was not
0x0001 FUNCTION implemented in the unit selected. It could also indicate that the server (or slave) is in the wrong
14 state to process a request of this type, for example because it is unconfigured and is being
asked to return registered values.
The data address received in the query is not an allowable address for the server (or slave).
More specifically, the combination of reference number and transfer length is invalid. For a
A controller with 100 registers, the PDU addresses the first register as 0, and the last one as 99.
ILLEGAL DATA If a request is submitted with a starting register address of 96 and a quantity of registers of 4,
0x0002 ADDRESS then the request will successfully operate (address-wise at least) on registers 96, 97, 98, 99. If
B a request is submitted with a starting register of 96 and a quantity of registers of 5, then the
request will fail with Exception code 0x02 "Illegal Data Address" since it attempts to operate on
registers 96, 97, 98, 99 and 100, and there is no register with address 100.
C A value contained in the query data field is not an allowable value for server (or slave). This
ILLEGAL DATA indicates a fault in the structure of the remainder of a complex request, such as that the implied
0x0003 VALUE length is incorrect. It specifically does NOT mean that a data item submitted for storage in a
register has a value outside the expectation of the application program, since the Modbus
D protocol is unaware of the significance of any particular value of any particular register.
SLAVE DEVICE An unrecoverable error occurred while the server (or slave) was attempting to perform the
0x0004 FAILURE requested action.

A–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

DirectLOGIC Error Code P499 Explanation


The P499 error code is used to show any errors that are generated by the connected PLC. The A
P499 error message includes a four digit hexadecimal value displayed at the end of the message.
This value can be found in the specific PLC’s error tables to determine the cause of the error.
The possible PLC generated error codes for the various Direct LOGIC communication
2
protocols breakdown into a four digit hexadecimal value.
3
DirectLOGIC – K-Sequence PLC Error Code Table
Direct LOGIC PLC Error Code Displayed Example: 4
P499: Recv. Err Code 0002
5
Start Stop
6
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
7
The following table lists the errors that can be generated by the DirectLOGIC PLC when using 8
the K-Sequence protocol.
Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
9
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
Please refer to the PLC users manual for additional information. 10
PLC Error Codes for Direct LOGIC – K-Sequence
Panel Error Code
11
Description
P499 Hex Value
01F8
020D
Error setting value.
Error in key mode.
12
021C Password protected.
13
DirectLOGIC – DirectNET PLC Error Codes
There are no PLC generated errors that occur when using the DirectNET protocol. 14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–5
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Allen-Bradley Error Code P499 Explanation


A The P499 error code is used to show any errors that are generated by the connected PLC. The
P499 error message includes a four digit hexadecimal value displayed at the end of the message.
2 This value can be looked up in the specific PLC’s error tables to determine the cause of the error.
The possible PLC generated error codes for the Allen-Bradley DF1 and DH485
communication protocol is represented by a hexadecimal value as shown in the following
3 diagram. Please note that the error code is broken down into three sections. It is possible for
more than one type of PLC error to be displayed in this value.
4 AB DF1 Protocol Error Code P499 Breakdown
Remote Local EXT STS
AB DF1 Protocol – Multiple Error Code Examples
4-7 bits 0-3 bits byte Example 1 Example 2 Example 3

5 16-bit
Word
1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 1 1
Remote
4-7 bits
Local
F x
+
x x 1 x
+
x x F x
+
x x

15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0-3 bits x 0 x x x 1 x x x 1 x x

6 EXT STS
byte x
+
x 0 9
=
x
+
x 0 0
=
x
+
x 0 9
=
Example of an EXT STS error Error P499
P499 Error Code Message for a “Type mismatch.” F 0 0 9 1 1 0 0 F 1 0 9

7 Displayed Hexadecimal Value F 0 1 7


hex
Value Displayed

8 Allen-Bradley PLC Error Code Displayed Example

9 Error Recieved = P499: Recv. Err Code 3200


Remote = 0x3000 = Remote node host is missing,
Remote
4-7 bits 3 x
+
x x

disconnected or shut down. Local


0-3 bits x 2 x x

10 Local - 0x0200 = Cannot Guarantee Delivery; Link


Layer. The remote node specified does not
ACK Command
EXT STS
byte
x x
+
0 0
=
EXT STS = 0000 = None Error P499
3 2 0 0
11 Value
Displayed

12 P499: Recv. Err Code F017

13 Start Stop

14
A F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

B
C
D

A–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables


The following PLC error tables cover possible errors that are detected by the panel from Allen- A
Bradley PLCs using the DF1 protocol. This includes full and half duplex communications for
the MicroLogix 1000, 1100. 1200 & 1500, SLC 5/03, /04, /05, ControlLogix, CompactLogix
and FlexLogix, and full duplex communications for the PLC5.
2
Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
3
Please refer to the PLC users manual for additional information.
4
PLC Errors for Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol, Remote STS Errors (4-7 bits)
Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description 5
0x0 Success; no error.
0x10 Illegal command or format. 6
0x20 Host has a problem and will not communicate.
0x30
0x40
Remote node host is missing, disconnected, or shut down.
Host could not complete function due to hardware fault.
7
0x50 Addressing problem or memory protect rungs.
0x60 Function not allowed due to command protection selection. 8
0x70 Processor is in Program Mode.
0x80
0x90
Compatibility mode file missing or communication zone problem.
Remote node cannot buffer command.
9
0xA0 Wait ACK (1775 KA buffer full).
0xB0 Remote node problem due to download. 10
0xC0 Wait ACK (1775 KA buffer full).
0xD0
0xE0
not used
not used
11
0xF0 Error code in the EXT STS byte. See the error code table on the next page.
12
PLC Errors for Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol, Local STS Errors (0-3 bits)
Panel Error Code Description
13
P499 Hex Value
0x0
0x1
Success; no error.
DST node is out of buffer space.
14
Cannot guarantee delivery; link layer.
0x2
0x3
(The remote node specified does not ACK command.)
Duplicate token holder detected.
A
0x4 Local port is disconnected.
0x5 Application layer timed out waiting for response. B
0x6 Duplicate node detected.
0x7
0x8
Station is offline.
Hardware fault.
C
(PLC generated error codes for the Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol continued on the next page.)
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–7
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


A PLC Errors for Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol, EXT STS Command Code for F0 Command
Panel Error Code
Description
2 P499 Hex Value
0x0 not used
0x1 A field has an illegal value.
3 0x2 Fewer levels specified in address than minimum for any address.
0x3 More levels specified in address than system supports.
4 0x4
0x5
Symbol not found.
Symbol is of improper format.
0x6 Address does not point to something usable.
5 0x7 File is wrong size.
0x8 Cannot complete request; situation has changed since start of the command.
6 0x9
0xA
Data or file size is too large.
Transaction size plus word address is too large.
0xB Access denied; improper privilege.
7 0xC Condition cannot be generated; resource is not available.
0xD Condition already exists; resource is readily available.
8 0xE
0xF
Command cannot be executed.
Histogram overflow.
0x10 No access.
9 0x11 Illegal data type.
0x12 Invalid parameter or invalid data.
10 0x13 Address reference exists to deleted area.
Command execution failure for unknown reason;
0x14 possible PLC 3 histogram overflow.
11 0x15
0x16
Data conversion error.
Scanner not able to communicate with 1771 rack adapter.
0x17 Type mismatch.
12 0x18 1771 module response was not valid.
0x19 Duplicated label.
13 0x22
0x23
Remote rack fault.
Timeout.
0x24 Unknown error.
14 0x1A File is open; another node owns it.
0x1B Another node is the program owner.
A 0x1C
0x1D
Reserved
Reserved
0x1E Data table element protection violation.
B 0x1F Temporary internal problem.

C
D

A–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables


The following PLC error code tables cover possible errors that are detected by the panel from A
Allen-Bradley PLCs using the DH485 protocol. This includes all MicroLogix and SLC500
PLCs, and any communication connection using an Allen-Bradley AIC device using the
DH485 protocol.
2
Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
3
Please refer to the PLC users manual for additional information.
4
PLC Errors for Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol, Local STS Errors (0-3 bits)
Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description 5
0x0 Success; no error.
0x1 DST node is out of buffer space. 6
0x2 Cannot guarantee delivery; link layer.
(The remote node specified does not ACK command.)
0x3 Duplicate token holder detected. 7
0x4 Local port is disconnected.
0x5
0x6
Application layer timed out waiting for response.
Duplicate node detected.
8
0x7 Station is offline.
0x8 Hardware fault. 9
PLC Errors for Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol, Remote STS Errors (4-7 bits) 10
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
0x0 Success; no error.
11
0x10 Illegal command or format.
0x20 Host has a problem and will not communicate. 12
0x30 Remote node host is missing, disconnected, or shut down.
0x40
0x50
Host could not complete function due to hardware fault.
Addressing problem or memory protect rungs.
13
0x60 Function not allowed due to command protection selection.
0x70 Processor is in Program Mode. 14
0x80 Compatibility mode file missing or communication zone problem.
0x90
0xA0
Remote node cannot buffer command.
Wait ACK (1775 KA buffer full).
A
0xB0 Remote node problem due to download.
0xC0 Wait ACK (1775 KA buffer full). B
0xD0 not used
0xE0
0xF0
not used
Error code in the EXT STS byte. See the error code table on the next page.
C
(PLC generated error codes for the Allen-Bradley DH485 protocol continued on the next
page.)
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–9
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


A
PLC Errors for Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol, EXT STS Command Code for F0 Command
2 Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description
0x7 Insufficient memory module size (0000h is returned).
3 0xB Access denied; privilege violation.
0xC Resource not available or cannot do.
4 0xE
0x12
CMD cannot be executed.
Invalid parameter.
0x14 Failure during processing.
5 0x19 Duplicate label.
0x1A File open by another node + owner's local node address, 1 byte.
6 0x1B Program owned by another node + program owner's local node address, 1 byte.

7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

A–10 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE Error Code P499 Explanation


The P499 error code is used to show any errors that are generated by the connected PLC. The A
P499 error message includes a four digit hexadecimal value displayed at the end of the message.
This value can be looked up in the specific PLC’s error tables to determine the cause of the error.
The possible PLC generated error codes for the GE 90-30, 90-70, Micro 90 and VersaMax
2
Micro SNPX communication protocols breakdown into a four digit hexadecimal value.
GE Error Code P499 Message Example:
3
P499: Recv. Err Code 020C
4
Start Stop
5
6
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–11
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables


A The following table lists the errors that can be generated by the GE 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax
PLC when using the SNPX protocol.
2 Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
3 Please refer to the PLC users manual for additional information.

PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Major)


4 Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description
No error Successful completion. (This is the expected completion value in the COMMREQ Status Word.)
5 0x0002 Insufficient Privilege. For Series 90-70 PLC, the minor error code contains the privilege level required for
the service request.
0x0004 Protocol Sequence Error. The CPU has received a message that is out of order.
6 0x0005 Service Request Error, the minor error code contains the specific error code.
0x0006 Illegal Mailbox Type. Service request mailbox type is either undefined or unexpected.
7 0x0007 The PLC CPU’s Service Request Queue is full. The master should retry later. It is recommended that the
master wait a minimum of 10 msec before sending another service request.
0x000A SNP DOS Driver Error. The minor error code contains the specific error code.
8 0x000B
Illegal Service Request. The requested service is either not defined or not supported. (This value is returned
in lieu of the actual 01h value passed in the SNP error message, to avoid confusion with the normal
successful COMMREQ completion.)
9 0x000C
Local SNP/SNP-X Error. An error occurred within the SNP task in the CMM module in this PLC.
This error may occur in either an SNP master or an SNP slave. The minor error code contains the specific
error code.
10 0x000D Remote SNP Error. An error occurred within the SNP slave task in the CMM module in the remote PLC.
The minor error code contains the specific error code.
0x000E Autodial Error. An error occurred while attempting to send a command string to an attached external
11 0x000F
modem. The minor error code contains the specific error code.
SNP-X slave error. An error occurred within the SNPX task in the remote slave device. The minor error
code contains the specific error code.
12 0x0013
0x0050
Port configurator error.
Problem with sending mail to the slave Service Request task.
(Series 90-70 PLC CPUs only)
13 0x0051 Problem with getting mail from the slave Service Request task.
(Series 90-70 PLC CPUs only)
0x0055 Slave SNP task timed out before receiving an SRP response.
14 0x0056
(Series 90-70 PLC CPUs only)
Slave SNP task could not find the requested datagram connection.
(Series 90-70 PLC CPUs only)

A 0x0057 Slave SNP task encountered an error in trying to write the datagram.
(Series 90-70 PLC CPUs only)
0x0058 Slave SNP task encountered an error in trying to update the datagram.
(Series 90-70 PLC CPUs only)
B (PLC generated error codes for the GE 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
continued on the next page.)
C
D

A–12 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol– PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d) A
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
PLC Error 0x010C WAIT-type COMMREQ is not permitted; must use NOW AIT-type.
2
PLC Error 0x010E Not used

PLC Error 0x010F The service request code in an X-Request message is unsupported or invalid at this time. This error may 3
occur if an SNP-X communication session has not been success fully established at the slave device.
PLC Error 0x020C
PLC Error 0x020E
COMMREQ command is not supported.
The modem command string length exceeds 250 characters.
4
Insufficient privilege level in the slave PLC CPU for the requested SNP-X service.
PLC Error 0x020F Password protection at PLC CPU may be preventing the requested service.
Unsupported COMMREQ. These errors are only generated when there is no protocol currently being run on
5
PLC Error 0x0213 a port, and the port receives a COMMREQ.
(The port may be disabled or an error has occurred in processing a new configuration).
SNP communication is not active. Must initiate a new SNP communication by sending an Attach or Long
6
PLC Error 0x030C Attach COMMREQ.
PLC Error 0x030E COMMREQ Data Block Length is too small.
Output command string data is missing or incomplete.
7
PLC Error 0x030F Invalid slave memory type in X-Request message.
PLC Error 0x0313 Invalid COMMREQ length. 8
PLC Error 0x040C SNP slave did not respond to Attach message from master.

PLC Error 0x040E Serial output timeout. The CMM module was unable to transmit the modem autodial output from the serial
port. (May be due to missing CTS signal when the CMM is configured to use hardware flow control.)
9
PLC Error 0x040F
PLC Error 0x0413
Invalid slave memory address or range in X-Request message.
Invalid COMMREQ status word location.
10
PLC Error 0x050C Unable to write SNP Status Word to local PLC memory;

PLC Error 0x050E


may be due to invalid Status Word memory type or address.
Response was not received from modem. Check modem and cable.
11
PLC Error 0x050F Invalid data length in X-Request message.

PLC Error 0x0513


Data length must be non-zero, and may not exceed decimal 1000 bytes.
Invalid COMMREQ data.
12
PLC Error 0x060C Master device memory type is not valid in this PLC.

PLC Error 0x060E


Modem responded with BUSY.
Modem is unable to complete the requested connection. The remote modem is already in use; retry the
13
connection request at a later time.

PLC Error 0x060F


X-Buffer data length does not match the service request in X-Request message.
The X-Buffer message length is obtained from the Next Message Length field in the X-Request message;
14
the length of the data within the buffer message is always the message length.
PLC Error 0x070C Master device memory address or length is zero.
Modem responded with NO CARRIER.
A
PLC Error 0x070E Modem is unable to complete the requested connection.
Check the local and remote modems and the telephone line.
Queue Full indication from Service Request Processor in slave PLC CPU.
B
The slave is temporarily unable to complete the service request.
PLC Error 0x070F The master should try again later. It is recommended that the master wait at least 10 msec before repeating
the X-Request.
C
(PLC generated error codes for the GE 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
continued on the next page.) D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–13
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol– PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


A PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d)
Panel Error Code Description
2 P499 Hex Value
0x080C Unable to read or write master device memory locations specified in COMMREQ. Usually caused by invalid
memory address for this PLC. SNP message exchange may have taken place.
3 0x080E Modem responded with NO DIALTONE. Modem is unable to complete the requested connection. Check the
modem connections and the telephone line.
Service Request Processor response exceeds 1000 bytes;
0x080F the SNP-X slave device cannot return the data in an X-Response message.
4 (This error applies to CMM module only.)

0x090C Master device memory data length exceeds maximum data size of CMM module (2048 bytes). Must use a
5 smaller data length. Use multiple COMMREQs if total data length exceeds this maximum value.
Modem responded with ERROR. Modem is unable to complete the requested command. Check the modem
0x090E command string and modem.
6 0x0A0C Slave device memory type is missing or not valid.
0x0A0E Modem responded with RING, indicating that the modem is being called by another modem. Modem is
unable to complete the requested command. Retry the modem command at a later time.
7 0x0B0C Slave device memory address is missing or zero.
An unknown response was received from the modem. Modem is unable to complete the requested
0x0B0E command. Check the modem command string and modem. The modem response is expected to be either
8 CONNECT or OK.
COMMREQ Data Block Length is too small.
0x0C0C (When expected COMMREQ length is 6 words or less. An improper length may cause other minor error
9 0x0D0C
codes 6-11.)
Invalid Diagnostic Status Word (DSW) starting word or length.

10 0x0E0C Invalid maximum SNP message data size.


Must be an even value from 42 to 2048.
0x0F0C Invalid Privilege Level. Must be 0 through 4 or -1.

11 0x100C Invalid Fault Table selector.


Must be 1 for I/O Fault Table, or 2 for PLC Fault Table.
Unexpected Service Request Processor error.
0x100F (This error applies to CMM module only; the unexpected SRP error code is saved in the Diagnostic Status
12 Words in the CMM module.)
0x110C Invalid Fault Table starting index.
Must be 1-32 for I/O Fault Table, or 1-16 for PLC.
13 0x120C Invalid fault count. Must be 1-32 for I/O Fault Table, or 1-16 for PLC Fault Table.
0x130C Invalid Set PLC Date/Time mode. Must be 1-4.
14 0x140C
0x150C
Invalid Set PLC Date/Time date, time, or day-of-week value.
Unable to retrieve master device PLC time/date from PLC CPU.
Requested service is not permitted in a Broadcast request. The master must direct the X-Request message
A 0x150F to a specific SNP-X slave device.
Invalid slave PLC type.
0x160C Must be 0 for Series 90-70, or 1 for Series 90-30 or Series 90-20.
B 0x170C Invalid datagram type.
Must be 01h for normal datagram, or 81h (129) for permanent datagram.
0x180C Missing or too many datagram point formats. Must be 1-32.
C 0x190C Invalid datagram point format data.

(PLC generated error codes for the GE 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
D continued on the next page.)

A–14 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol– PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d) A
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
0x1A0C Datagram area size is too small to include data for all specified point formats.
2
0x1B0C Invalid number of Control Program Names. Must be 1-8.
0x1C0C SNP-X Request exceeds maximum data size (1000 bytes).
Must use a smaller data length. Use multiple COMMREQs if necessary.
3
0x1D0C Invalid SNP-X communication session type.
Must be 0 for a single slave device, or 1 for multiple slave devices.
Illegal destination SNP ID specified for SNP-X slave. Must be 0-7 ASCII characters, plus a terminating null
4
0x1E0C character (00h). The Null SNP ID (eight bytes of 00h) may be used to specify any single device. The
Broadcast SNP ID (eight bytes of FFh) may be use to specify all slave devices on the serial link.
Destination SNP ID does not match SNP-X session type.
5
0x1F0C The Broadcast SNP ID is not permitted in a single-slave SNP-X session.

0x200C
The Null SNP ID is not permitted in a multiple-slave SNP-X session.
Inactivity timeout (T3’). The SNP slave has not received any new SNP messages within the configured T3’ 6
time interval.
0x200F Invalid Message Type field in a received X-Request message.
The message type of an X-Request message must be 58h = ’X’. 7
0x210C A Parity error has occurred on an Attach, Attach Response, or Update Real–time Datagram message.
Communications have not been established.
Invalid Next Message Type or Next Message Length field in a received X Request message. If this request
does not use a buffer (0-2 bytes of data), the Next Message Type must be zero. If this request will be
8
0x210F followed with a buffer message (more than 2 byte.)), the Next Message Type must be 54h = ’T’, and the
Next Message Length must specify the length of the X-Buffer message. Valid X-Buffer message lengths are
9-1008 bytes (data length plus 8 bytes).
9
A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred on an Attach, Attach Response, or Update Realtime
0x220C Datagram message. Communications have not been established.
Invalid Message Type field in a received X-Buffer message.
10
0x220F The message type of an X-Buffer message must be 54h = ’T’.
0x230C A Framing or Overrun serial error has occurred on an Attach, Attach Response, or Update Realtime
Datagram message. Communications have not been established.
11
0x230F Invalid Next Message Type field in a received X-Buffer message. Since an X-Buffer message is never

0x240C
followed by another message, the Next Message Type must always be zero.
An invalid SNP message type was received when an Attach, Attach Response, or Update Realtime
12
Datagram message was required. Communications have not been established.
0x250C An invalid next message length value was specified in an Attach, Attach Response, or Update Realtime
Datagram message. Communications have not been established. 13
0x260C An unexpected SNP message type was received when an Attach, Attach Response, or Update Realtime
Datagram was required. Communications have not been established.
0x270C Another Break was received while SNP slave was waiting for an Attach or Update Realtime Datagram
message.
14
An SNP message has been sent and retried the maximum number of times.
0x280C A maximum of two retries are permitted.
A retry is caused by a NAK from from the remote SNP device.
A
A received SNP message has been NAKed the maximum number of two times.
0x290C The NAKed message may be retransmitted a maximum of two times. B
(PLC generated error codes for the GE 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
continued on the next page.) C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–15
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol– PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


A PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d)
Panel Error Code
Description
2 P499 Hex Value
0x2A0C An unknown message was received when an acknowledge (ACK or NAK) was required.
0x2B0C Sequence Error. An unexpected SNP message type was received.
3 0x2C0C Received SNP message contains bad next message length value.
Acknowledge timeout. An acknowledge (ACK or NAK) was not received within the configured T2 time
0x2D0C interval. A slave device may generate this error if the master device has aborted after maximum response
4 NAKs and does not NAK the next response retry.
Response timeout. The SNP Master did not receive an SNP Response message within the configured T5’
0x2E0C time interval.
5 0x2F0C Buffer message timeout. An expected Text Buffer or Connection Data message was not received within the
configured T5’’ time interval.
Serial output timeout. The CMM module was unable to transmit a Break, an SNP message, or SNP
6 0x300C acknowledge (ACK or NAK) from the serial port. (May be due to missing CTS signal when the CMM
module is configured to use hardware flow control.)
0x310C SNP slave did not receive a response from the Service Request Processor in the PLC CPU.
7 0x320C COMMREQ timeout.
The COMMREQ did not complete within the configured time interval.
0x330C An SNP Request or Response was aborted prior to completion due to reception of a Break.
8 0x340C PLC backplane communications error
0x350C Invalid Piggyback Status data memory type or address.
Communications have not been established.
9 0x360C Invalid SNP Slave SNP ID. Must be a 0-7 ASCII characters, plus a terminating null character (00h). The Null
SNP ID (eight bytes of 00h) may be used to specify any single slave device.
The SNP master has received a response message containing an unexpected data length. Usually indicates
10 0x370C a problem with the remote SNP slave device. May occur when Series 90-70 commands (Task Memory or
Program Block Memory Read/Write) are issued to a Series 90-30 slave device.
Response code in received SNP-X response message does not match expected value. (Response code
11 0x380C must equal the request code +80h.)
SNP-X Response message exceeds maximum data size (decimal 1000 bytes).
0x390C Data in the Response is ignored.
12 0x400C A parity error has occurred on an X-Attach Response message when establishing a new SNP-X
communication session. Communications have not been established.
0x400D The requested service is not supported by the SNP slave.
13 0x400F Serial output timeout. The slave was unable to transmit an SNP-X message from the serial port. (May be
due to missing CTS signal when the CMM module is configured to use hardware flow control.)

14 (PLC generated error codes for the GE Fanuc 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
continued on the next page.)
A
B
C
D

A–16 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d) A
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
A framing or overrun error has occurred on an X-Attach Response message when establishing a new SNP-
2
0x410C X communication session.
Communications have not been established.
0x410D SNP slave on CMM module requires PLC CPU privilege level 2 to operate. The SNP slave has rejected a 3
request to change to a higher or lower privilege level.
0x410F An SNP-X request was aborted prior to completion due to reception of a Break.
A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred on an X-Attach Response message when establishing a new
4
0x420C SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established.
SNP Request or Response message exceeds maximum data length of the CMM module. (Total data length 5
0x420D for Mailbox and all following Buffer messages is 2048 bytes.) The master must use a smaller data length.
Use multiple requests if total data length exceeds the maximum value.
0x420F An X-Buffer message was received containing greater than 1000 bytes of data. The data is ignored. 6
An invalid message type was received when an X-Attach Response was required when establishing a new
0x430C SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established. 7
Improper Write Datagram message format. Series 90-70 slave devices use a different format for this
0x430D
message than Series 90-30 or Series 90-20 slave devices. The master must use the proper message
format for this SNP slave device. (The SNP master in the CMMmodule sends this message as part of the
Establish Datagram COMMREQ command. The datagram has been partially established, but is not usable;
8
the datagram should be cancelled by using the Datagram ID returned by the COMMREQ.)
0x430F The SNP-X slave did not receive a response from the Service Request Processor in the PLC CPU. 9
An invalid next message type value was detected in an X-Attach Response message when establishing a
0x440C new SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established. 10
0x440D A datagram error occurred in a Series 90-70 slave device (dual-port error).
0x440F PLC backplane communications error.
An invalid response code was detected in an X-Attach Response message when establishing a new SNP-X
11
0x450C communication session.
Communications have not been established.
An expected X-Attach Response message was not received within the response timeout interval when
12
0x460C establishing a new SNP-X communication session. The master has retried the X-Attach message twice
without receiving a response.
Communications have not been established. 13
A parity error has occurred on an X-Attach Response message when re-establishing an existing SNP-X
0x500C communication session.
Communications have not been established. 14
0x500F A parity error has occurred in a received X-Attach message.

0x510C
A framing or overrun error has occurred on an X-Attach Response message when re-establishing an
existing SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established.
A
0x510F A framing or overrun error has occurred in a received X-Attach message.
A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred on an X-Attach Response message when re-establishing an
B
0x520C existing SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established.
0x520F A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred in a received X-Attach message. C
(PLC generated error codes for the GE Fanuc 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
continued on the next page.) D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–17
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol– PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


A PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d)
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
2 An invalid message type was received when an X-Attach Response was required when re-establishing an
0x530C existing SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established.
3 0x530F An invalid Message Type was received when an X-Attach message was required. (For an X-Attach message,
the message type must be 58h = ’T’.)

4 0x540C
An invalid Next Message Type value was detected in an X-Attach Response message when re-establishing
an existing SNP-X communication session.
Communications have not been established.
An invalid Next Message Type value was detected in a received X-Attach message. (For an X-Attach
5 0x540F message, the Next Message Length must be zero.)
An invalid response code was detected in an X-Attach Response message when re-establishing an existing
0x550C SNP-X communication session.
6 0x550F
Communications have not been established.
An invalid request code was detected in a received X-Attach message.
An expected X-Attach Response message was not received within the response timeout interval when re-
7 0x560C establishing an existing SNP-X communication session. The master has retried the X-Attach message twice
without receiving a response. Communications have not been established.
0x600C A parity error has occurred on an X-Response message.
8 0x600F A parity error has occurred in a received X-Request message.
0x610C A framing or overrun error has occurred on an X-Response message.
9 0x610F
0x620C
A framing or overrun error has occurred in a received X-Request message.
A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred on an X-Response message.
0x620F A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred in a received X-Request message.
10 0x630C An invalid message type was received when an X-Response message was required.
0x640C An invalid next message type value was detected in an X-Response message.
11 0x650C
0x660C
An invalid response code was detected in an X-Response message.
An expected X-Response message was not received within the response time.
0x700C A parity error has occurred on an Intermediate Response message.
12 0x700F A parity error has occurred in a received X-Buffer message.
0x710C A framing or overrun error has occurred on an Intermediate Response message.
13 0x710F
0x720C
A framing or overrun error has occurred in a received X-Buffer message.
A BCC (Block Check Code) error has occurred on an Intermediate Response message.
0x720F A BCC(Block Check Code) error has occurred in a received X-Buffer message.
14 0x730C An invalid message type was received when an Intermediate Response message was required.
0x730F An expected X-Buffer message was not received.
A 0x740C
0x750C
An invalid next message type value was detected in an Intermediate Response message.
An invalid response code was detected in an Intermediate Response message.
0x760C An expected Intermediate Response message was not received within the response timeout interval.
B
(PLC generated error codes for the GE Fanuc 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol
C continued on the next page.)

A–18 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol – PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d) A
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
0x8D0A Bad DOS Version. Must have DOS 2.0, or later, to support the SNP DOS Driver.
2
0x8E0A PC Serial port configured for SNP Master driver is not open; no communication can take place.
0x8F0A Out–of–Sequence SNP message. SNP message type received was not the type expected.
Bad SNP BCC encountered. Transmission was aborted after maximum retries due to a bad Block Check
3
0x900A Code.
0x910A Bad SNP communication. Transmission was aborted after maximum retries due to serial errors (that is,
parity, overrun, or framing errors).
4
No SNP communication. Either communication has been lost or a communication session has not been
0x920A
0xC105
established.
Invalid block state transition.
5
0xC205 The OEM key is NULL (inactive).
0xC305 Text length does not match traffic type. 6
0xC405 Verify with FA Card or EEPROM failed.
0xC505
0xC605
No task–level Rack/Slot configuration to read or delete.
Control Program (CP) tasks exist but requestor not logged into main CP.
7
0xC705 Passwords are set to inactive and cannot be enabled or disabled.
0xC805 Password(s) already enabled and can not be forced inactive. 8
0xC905 Login using non–zero buffer size required for block commands.
0xCA05
0xCB05
Device is write–protected.
A comm or write verify error occurred during save or restore.
9
0xCC05 Data stored on device has been corrupted and is no longer reliable.
0xCD05 Attempt was made to read a device but no data has been stored on it. 10
0xCE05 Specified device has insufficient memory to handle request.
0xCF05
0xD005
Specified device is not available in the system (not present).
One or more PLC modules configured have unsupported revision.
11
0xD105 Packet size or total program size does not match input.
0xD205 Invalid write mode parameter. 12
0xD305 User Program Module (UPM) read or write exceeded block end.
0xD405
0xD505
Mismatch of configuration checksum.
Invalid block name specified in datagram.
13
0xD605 Total datagram connection memory exceeded.
0xD705 Invalid datagram type specified. 14
0xD805 Point length not allowed.
0xD905
0xDA05
Transfer type invalid for this Memory Type selector.
Null pointer to data in Memory Type selector.
A
0xDB05 Invalid Memory Type selector in datagram.
0xDC05 Unable to find connection address. B
0xDD05 Unable to locate given datagram connection ID.
0xDE05
0xDF05
Size of datagram connection invalid.
Invalid datagram connection address.
C
(PLC generated error codes for the GE Fanuc 90-30, 90-70 and VersaMax SNPX protocol D
continued on the next page.)

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–19
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

GE SNPX Protocol– PLC Error Code Tables (cont’d)


A PLC Errors for GE SNPX Protocol (Minor-Major) (cont’d)
Panel Error Code Description
2 P499 Hex Value
0xE005 Service in process cannot login.
0xE105 No I/O configuration to read or delete.
3 0xE205
0xE305
IOS could not delete configuration, or bad type.
CPU revision number does not match.

4 0xE405
0xE505
Memory Type for this selector does not exist.
DOS file area not formatted.
0xE605 CPU model number does not match.
5 0xE705
0xE805
Configuration is not valid.
No user memory is available to allocate.

6 0xE905
0xEA05
Memory Type selector not valid in context.
Not logged in to process service request.
0xEB05 Task unable to be deleted.
7 0xEC05
0xED05
Task unable to be created.
VME bus error encountered.

8 0xEE05
0xEF05
Could not return block sizes.
Programmer is already attached.
0xF005 Request only valid in stop mode.
9 0xF105
0xF205
Request only valid from programmer.
Invalid program cannot log in.

10 0xF305
0xF405
I/O configuration mismatch.
Invalid input parameter in request.
0xF505 Invalid password.
11 0xF605
0xF705
Invalid sweep state to set.
Required to log in to a task for service.

12 0xF805
0xF905
Invalid Task Name referenced.
Task address out of range.
0xFA05 Cannot replace I/O module.
13 0xFB05
0xFC05
Cannot clear I/O configuration.
I/O configuration is invalid.

14 0xFD05
0xFE05
Unable to perform auto configuration.
No privilege for attempted operation.
0xFF05 Service Request Error has been aborted.
A
B
C
D

A–20 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Mitsubishi FX Protocol – PLC Error Codes


Only errors as listed in the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Error Code Table shown on page A-3 A
can occur when using the Mitsubishi FX protocol, there are no PLC generated errors.

Mitsubishi Q / QnA Series – PLC Error Codes 2


The following table lists the errors that can be generated by the Mitsubisht Q / QnA Series PLC
when using the Q / QnA protocol.
3
Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
4
Please refer to the PLC users manual for additional information.
5
PLC Error Codes for Mitsubishi Q / QnA and Q Series
Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description 6
0x4000 Serial communications checksum error. Check cable and grounding.
0x4001
0x4002
Unsupported request sent to PLC.
Unsupported request sent to PLC.
7
0x4003
0x4004
Global request sent to PLC that cannot be executed.
System protect switch is on and request was sent that cannot be executed.
8
Also PLC, may still be booting up.
0x4005
0x4006
Packet sent is too large according to size request in header.
Serial communications could not be initialized.
9
0x4008 CPU busy or buffer full.
0x4010 Request cannot be serviced while CPU is running. CPU must be stopped. 10
0x4013 Request cannot be serviced while CPU is running. CPU must be stopped.
0x4021
0x4022
Drive memory does not exist.
File (ZR memory) does not exist.
11
0x4023 File (ZR memory) name and File (ZR memory) number do not match.
0x4024 File (ZR memory) inaccessible by user. 12
0x4025 File (ZR memory) is locked by another device.
0x4026
0x4027
File (ZR memory) password required.
Specified range is out of File (ZR memory) range.
13
0x4028 File (ZR memory) already exist.
0x4029 Specified File (ZR memory) capacity cannot be retrieved. 14
0x402A Specified File (ZR memory) is abnormal.
0x402B
0x402C
The requested data cannot be executed in the specified drive memory.
The requested operation cannot be executed presently.
A
0x4030 The specified data type does not exist. Check the CPUs allowable data types.
0x4031 The specified address is out of range. The data type requested may need to be expanded in GX developer.
The CPU may not allow this data type.
B
0x4032 Address qualification is incorrect.
0x4033 Cannot write to system area. C
0x4034 Request cannot be executed because completion address for an instruction cannot be turned on.
(PLC generated error codes for the Mitsubishi Q / QnA protocol continued on the next D
page.)

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–21
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Mitsubishi Q / QnA Series – PLC Error Codes (cont’d)


A PLC Error Codes for Mitsubishi Q / QnA and Q Series
Panel Error Code
2 P499 Hex Value
0x4040 Module doesn't support request.
Description

0x4041 Request is out of module's range.


3 0x4042 Module cannot be accessed.
0x4043 Address for specified module is incorrect.
4 0x4044
0x4050
Hardware problem exist for specified module.
Request cannot be executed because memory card protect switch is on.
0x4051 Specified memory cannot be accessed.
5 0x4052 Specified memory attribute is read only and cannot be written to.
0x4053 Error occurred when writing to specified memory location.
6 0x4080
0x4082
Request data error. Check cabling and electrical noise.
Specified request is already being executed.
0x408B The remote request cannot be performed.
7 0x40A0 A block number out of range was specified.
0x40A1 The number of blocks requested exceeds the range of the PLC.
8 0x40A2
0x40A3
A step number was specified out of range.
Step range limit exceeded.
0x40A4 Specified sequence step number is out of range.
9 0x40A5 Specified SFC device is out of range.
0x40A6 Block specification and step specification are incorrect.
10 0x4100
0x4101
CPU module hardware fault.
Serial communication connection incorrect.
0x4105 CPU module internal memory fault. Bad CPU.
11 0x4106 CPU is in initialization. Wait until CPU is booted up.
0x4107 Specified function not supported by this CPU. Check memory types for that CPU.
12 0x4110
0x4111
Specified function not supported because CPU is in Stop. Put CPU in Run.
System is not up yet. Wait until system is up before performing request.
0x4A01 The network number specified does not exist. Routing not supported in C-more.
13 0x4A02 Station number specified does not exist. Routing not supported in C-more.

14
A
B
C
D

A–22 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Omron Error Code P499 Explanation


The P499 error code is used to show any errors that are generated by the connected PLC. The A
P499 error message includes a four digit hexadecimal value displayed at the end of the message.
This value can be looked up in the specific PLC’s error tables to determine the cause of the error.
The possible PLC generated error codes for the Omron Host Link communication protocols
2
breakdown into a four digit hexadecimal value.
Omron Error Code P499 Message Example:
3
P499: Recv. Err Code 0016
4
Start Stop
5
6
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–23
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Omron Host Link Protocol – PLC Error Code Table


A The following table lists the errors that can be generated by the Omron PLC when using the
Host Link protocol.
2 Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro-
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
3 Please refer to the PLC manufacturer’s documentation for additional information.

PLC Error Codes for Omron Host Link


4 Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description
0x00 Normal Completion.
5 0x01 Not executable in RUN mode.
0x02 Not executable in MONITOR mode.
6 0x03
0x04
Not executable with PROM mounted.
Address over (data overflow).
0x0B Not executable in PROGRAM mode.
7 0x0C Not executable in DEBUG mode.
0x0D Not executable in LOCAL mode.
8 0x10
0x11
Parity error.
Framing error.
0x12 Overrun.
9 0x13 FCS error.
0x14 Format error (parameter length error).
10 0x15
0x16
Entry number data error (parameter error, data code error, data length error).
Instruction not found.
0x18 Frame length error.
11 0x19 Not executable (due to Un-executable error clear, non-registration of I/O table, etc.).
0x20 I/O table generation impossible (unrecognized remote I/O unit, channel over, duplication of optical
transmitting I/O unit).
12 0xA0 Abort due to parity error in transmit data under process.
0xA1 Abort due to framing error in transmit data under process.
13 0xA2
0xA3
Abort due to overrun in transmit data under process.
Abort due to FCS error in transmit data under process.
0xA4 Abort due to format error in transmit data under process.
14 0xA5 Abort due to frame length error in transmit data under process.
0xA8 Abort due to entry number data error in transmit data under process.
A 0xB0 Un-executable due to program area capacity other than 16k bytes.

B
C
D

A–24 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Omron FINS Protocol – PLC Error Code Table


The following table lists the errors that can be generated by the Omron PLC when using the A
FINS protocol.
Note: The following errors can be generated from the designated PLC, are monitored by the C-more Micro- 2
Graphic panel, and displayed on the panel’s screen as a hexadecimal value in panel error code P499, if active.
Please refer to the PLC manufacturer’s documentation for additional information.
3
PLC Error Codes for Omron FINS
Panel Error Code
P499 Hex Value Description 4
0x0000 Normal Completion.
0x0001 Service Canceled. 5
0x0101 Local Error: Local node not in network.
0x0102
0x0103
Local Error: Token Timeout.
Local Error: Retries Failed.
6
0x0104 Local Error: Too many send frames.
0x0105 Local Error: Node address range error. 7
0x0106 Local Error: Node Address Duplication.
0x0201
0x0202
Destination Node Error: Destination Node not in network.
Destination Node Error: Unit Missing.
8
0x0203 Destination Node Error: Third Node missing.
0x0204 Destination Node Error: Destination Node busy. 9
0x0205 Destination Node Error: Response Timeout.
0x0301
0x0302
Controller Error: Communications Controller Error.
Controller Error: CPU Unit Error.
10
0x0303 Controller Error: Controller Error.
0x0304 Controller Error: Unit number Error. 11
0x0401 Service Unsupported: Undefined Command.
0x0402
0x0501
Service Unsupported: Not supported by Model/Version.
Routing Table Error: Destination address setting error.
12
0x0502 Routing Table Error: No routing tables.
0x0503 Routing Table Error: Routing table error. 13
0x0504 Routing Table Error: Too many delays.
0x1001
0x1002
Command Format Error: Command too long.
Command Format Error: Command too short.
14
0x1003 Command Format Error: Elements/Data don't match.
0x1004 Command Format Error: Command format error. A
0x1005 Command Format Error: Header Error.
0x1101
0x1102
Parameter Error: Area classification missing.
Parameter Error: Access Size Error.
B
0x1103 Parameter Error: Address range error.
C
(PLC generated error codes for the Omron FINS protocol continued on the next page.)
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–25
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Omron FINS Protocol – PLC Error Code Table (cont’d)


A PLC Error Codes for Omron FINS
Panel Error Code Description
2 P499 Hex Value
0x1104 Parameter Error: Address range exceeded.
0x1106 Parameter Error: Program Missing.
3 0x1109
0x110A
Parameter Error: Relational Error.
Parameter Error: Duplicate Data Access.

4 0x110B
0x110C
Parameter Error: Response too long.
Parameter Error: Parameter Error.
0x2002 Read Not Possible: Protected.
5 0x2003
0x2004
Read Not Possible: Table missing.
Read Not Possible: Data missing.

6 0x2005
0x2006
Read Not Possible: Program missing.
Read Not Possible: File missing.
0x2007 Read Not Possible: Data mismatch.
7 0x2101
0x2102
Write Not Possible: Read Only.
Write Not Possible: Protected - cannot write data link table.

8 0x2103
0x2105
Write Not Possible: Cannot register.
Write Not Possible: Program missing.
0x2106 Write Not Possible: File missing.
9 0x2107
0x2108
Write Not Possible: File name already exists.
Write Not Possible: Cannot change.

10 0x2201
0x2202
Not executable in current mode: Not possible during execution.
Not executable in current mode: Not possible while running.
0x2203 Not executable in current mode: Wrong PLC mode (Program).
11 0x2204
0x2205
Not executable in current mode: Wrong PLC mode (Debug).
Not executable in current mode: Wrong PLC mode (Monitor).

12 0x2206
0x2207
Not executable in current mode: Wrong PLC mode (Run).
Not executable in current mode: Specified node not polling node.
0x2208 Not executable in current mode: Step cannot be executed.
13 0x2301
0x2302
No such device: File device missing.
No such device: Missing memory.

14 0x2303
0x2401
No such device: Clock missing.
Cannot Start/Stop: Table missing.
0x2502 Unit Error: Memory Error.
A 0x2503
0x2504
Unit Error: I/O setting Error.
Unit Error: Too many I/O points.

B 0x2505
0x2506
Unit Error: CPU bus error.
Unit Error: I/O Duplication.

C (PLC generated error codes for the Omron FINS protocol continued on the next page.)

A–26 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Omron FINS Protocol – PLC Error Code Table (cont’d)


PLC Error Codes for Omron FINS A
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
0x2507 Unit Error: I/O bus error.
2
0x2509 Unit Error: SYSMAC BUS/2 error.
0x250A
0x250D
Unit Error: CPU Bus Unit Error.
Unit Error: SYSMAC BUS No. duplication.
3
0x250F
0x2510
Unit Error: Memory Error.
Unit Error: SYSMAC BUS terminator missing.
4
0x2601 Command Error: No protection.
0x2602
0x2604
Command Error: Incorrect password.
Command Error: Protected.
5
0x2605
0x2606
Command Error: Service already executing.
Command Error: Service stopped.
6
0x2607 Command Error: No execution right.
0x2608
0x2609
Command Error: Settings not complete.
Command Error: Necessary items not set.
7
0x260A
0x260B
Command Error: Number already defined.
Command Error: Error will not clear.
8
0x3001 Access Right Error: No access right.
0x4001 Abort: Service aborted. 9
10
11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–27
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Siemens Error Code P499 Explanation


A The P499 error code is used to show any errors that are generated by the connected PLC. The
P499 error message includes a four digit hexadecimal value displayed at the end of the message.
2 This value can be looked up in the specific PLC’s error tables to determine the cause of the error.
The possible PLC generated error codes for the Siemens PPI communication protocols
breakdown into a four digit hexadecimal value as shown in the following diagram.
3 Siemens PPI Error Code P499 Breakdown
Relay Main response Sub response
4 error flag code code

16-bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 0
5 Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0

6 P499 Error Code Message


Displayed Hexadecimal Value 0 0 0 6
hex
Example of a Siemens PPI error
for a “Address out of range.” error.

7 Siemens Error Code P499 Message Example:

8 P499: Recv. Err Code 0006

9 Start Stop

10
F1 F2 F3 F4 F5

11
12
13
14
A
B
C
D

A–28 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Appendix A: Panel & PLC Error Code Tables

Siemens PPI Protocol – PLC Error Code Table


PLC PDU Header Errors for S7-200 PPI A
Panel Error Code Description
P499 Hex Value
0x0001 Hardware Fault.
2
0x0003 Object access not allowed.
0x0004 Context not supported. 3
0x0005 Address out of range.
0x0006
0x0007
Address out of range.
Write Data size mismatch.
4
0x000A Object does not exist.
0x8000 Function being used. 5
0x8001 Action is not allowed in current mode.
0x8101
0x8103
Hardware fault.
Access not allowed.
6
0x8104 Function not supported.
0x8105 Address invalid. 7
0x8106 Data Type not supported.
0x8107
0x810A
Data Type is not consistent with size.
Object does not exist.
8
0x8500 PDU Size is incorrect.
0x8702 Address is invalid. 9
0xD201 Block name syntax error.
0xD202
0xD203
Error with function parameter.
Error with block type.
10
0xD204 No linked block.
0xD205 Object already exists. 11
0xD206 Object already exists.
0xD207
0xD209
Block already used in EPROM.
Block does not exist.
12
0xD20E No Block does not exist.
0xD210 Block number incorrect. 13
14
A
B
C
D
®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 A–29
MICRO-GRAPHIC PANEL APPENDIX
RUNTIME ERRORS
B
In This Appendix...
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B–2
Panel Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B–2
Appendix B: Micro-Graphic Panel Runtime Errors

Introduction
1 The runtime errors detected by the C-more® Micro-Graphic panel will display in a popup
window in the center of the panel display. The most common cause for runtime errors is a
B bad serial connection during a project transfer or firmware update. To resolve the problem,
try the following steps in the order shown:
1. Check that all connections are secure and cables are in good condition.
3 2. Cycle power to the panel.
3. Reset factory default system settings.
4 4. Transfer the project again.

5 Panel Errors
If more than one panel error occurs, each error message will display sequentially for three
6 seconds with a two second delay between each message.
When only one panel error is active, that message will display continuously until it is no longer
7 active.
Micro-Graphic Panel Errors
8 Error Code Error Message Possible Solutions
Check cables and connections.
R001 PC software tool Timeout
Cycle power at the panel.
9 CRC Error occurred during
See Chapter 8 for Electrical Noise Problems.
Check the area for sources of noise: electrical motors, transformers, etc.
R002 project transfer from PC. Check for proper grounding
10 R003 Project Check Sum Error.
Resend the project.

Resend Project file to Panel.


Cycle power.
11 R004
Protocol Module Check Sum
Error. Resend Project File to
Resend the project.
Panel

12 R005
Panel Check Sum Error. Panel
Info (Not Project) will be From the Setup Menu screen, reset panel options.
initialized.

13 R006 SW Ver. Mismatch. Use


software Ver.xx.xx. Update to current version programming software and panel firmware.

Option module detected EA-MG-SP1 or EA-MG-P1 optional power adapter module is installed
R100 on a C-more 3” Micro-Graphic panel without a 12-24 VDC power
14 without external power source. Provide 12-24 VDC power to the optional module.
EA-MG-SP1 or EA-MG-P1 optional power adapter module for a C-more
R101 Unsupported module detected 3” Micro-Graphic panel is installed on a C-more 6” Micro-Graphic panel.
A Remove the EA-MG-SP1 or EA-MG-P1.

B
C
D

B–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
INDEX

A
Accessing the System Setup Screens, 5–3
Accessories, 3–2
EA-MG-BZ1, 3–2, 3–8, 3–9
EA-MG-BZ2, 3–2
EA-MG-COV-CL, 3–2
EA-MG-P1, 3–2
EA-MG-PGM-CBL, 3–2
EA-MG-PGMSW, 3–2
EA-MG-SP1, 3–2
Agency Approvals, 1–5
Available Models, 2–2
Available PLC Protocols, 6–2

B
Built-in Port 1, 6–3

C
Cables, 6–20
Available Purchased, 6–20
User Constructed, 6–32
Wiring Diagrams, 6–22
Chemical Compatibility, 2–7
Communications Ports, 2–6
Port 1 (built-in), 2–6
Port 2 (optional), 2–6
Conventions Used, 1–3
Index

D
DC Power Adapter, 3–14
Dimensions, 3–14
EA-MG-P1, 3–14
Installed onto a Panel, 3–16
Installed onto a Panel with 8-Button Keypad Bezel, 3–17
Panel Overall Depth with Adapter Installed, 3–14
Specifications, 3–15
Wiring Diagram, 3–14
Dimensions, 2–5
DirectLOGIC PLCs TERM Mode & Password Protection, 6–5

E
Enclosure Thickness, 2–5
Error Code P499 Explanation, A–5
Allen-Bradley, A–6
DirectLOGIC, A–5
GE, A–11
Modbus Protocols, A–4
AutomationDirect CLICK, A–4
AutomationDirect DirectLOGIC - Modbus (Koyo), A–4
Entivity Modbus RTU, A–4
Modicon Modbus RTU, A–4
Omron, A–23
Siemens, A–28

F
Function Keys Insert Label, 9–4
Customizing, 9–4

I
Installation and Wiring, 4–3
Cutout Dimensions, 4–4
Enclosure Mounting Thickness Ranges, 4–4
Introduction, 4–3

i–2 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Index

Mounting Bracket Screw Torque, 4–4

K
Keypad Bezel, 3–8
20-button, 3–11
Assembly, 3–13
Dimensions, 3–11
EA-MG-BZ2, 3–11
Panel Cutout, 3–11
Panel Thickness, 3–11
Specifications, 3–12
8-Button, 3–8
Assembly, 3–10
Dimensions, 3–8
Panel Cutout, 3–8
Panel Thickness, 3–8
Specifications, 3–9

M
Maintenance, 7–2
Check Operating Environment, 7–2
Check Operating Voltage, 7–2
Check Physical Conditions, 7–3
Check Project Functionality, 7–6
Check Settings under the System Setup Screens, 7–5
Check Transmit and Receive Indicators, 7–3
Checks from the C-more Micro-Graphic Programming Software, 7–6
Cleaning the Display Screen, 7–5
Project Backup, 7–2
Run Tests under the System Setup Screens, 7–4
Mounting Clip Screw Torque, 2–5

O
Optional EA-MG-SP1 Port 2, 6–4

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 i–3
Index

P
Panel & PLC Error Code Tables, A–2
Allen-Bradley DF1 Protocol, A–7, A–8
Allen-Bradley DH485 Protocol, A–9, A–10
C-more Micro-Graphic Panel, A–3, A–4
DirectLOGIC – K-Sequence PLC, A–5
GE SNPX Protocol, A–12, A–13, A–14, A–15, A–16, A–17, A–18, A–19, A–20
Introduction, A–2
Mitsubishi FX Protocol, A–21
Mitsubishi Q / QnA Series, A–21
Omron FINS Protocol, A–25, A–26, A–27
Omron Host Link Protocol, A–24
Siemens PPI Protocol, A–29
Panel Objects, 3–4, 3–5
Adjust Display Contrast, 3–5
Analog Meter, 3–4
Bar Meter, 3–4
Bitmap Button, 3–4
Circle, 3–4
Dynamic Bitmap, 3–5
Dynamic Text, 3–5
Frame, 3–4
Function, 3–5
Graphic Indicator Light, 3–4
Increment/Decrement Value, 3–4
Indicator Button, 3–4
Indicator Light, 3–4
Line, 3–4
Line Graph, 3–4
Lookup Text, 3–5
Numeric Display, 3–4
Numeric Entry, 3–4
Pushbutton, 3–4
Real Time Graph, 3–4
Recipe, 3–5
Rectangle, 3–4
Screen Change Pushbutton, 3–5

i–4 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Index

Screen Selector, 3–5


Scroll Text, 3–5
Static Bitmap, 3–4
Static Text, 3–5
Switch, 3–4
Part Number Key, 1–5
PC Requirements, 3–3
PLC Communications, 6–2
Introduction, 6–2
PLC Compatibility and Connection Charts, 6–5
Allen-Bradly PLCs, 6–16
AutomationDirect CLICK PLC, 6–8
DirectLOGIC DL05, DL06, D0-DCM Module & DL105 PLCs, 6–8
DirectLOGIC DL205 PLCs, D2-DCM Module and WINPLC, 6–10
DirectLOGIC DL305 PLCs and D3-DCM Module, 6–12
DirectLOGIC DL405 PLCs and D4-DCM Module, 6–14
GE, Mitsubishi, Omron, Modicon and Siemens PLCs, 6–18
Product Label Examples, 1–6
Product Overview, 1–4
Programming Cable Assembly, 3–6
Converter, 3–6
Dimensions, 3–6
Status LEDs, 3–6
USB Connectivity, 3–6
USB to RS-232, 3–6
Programming Software, 3–3

Q
Quick Start Steps, 1–7
Step 1 – Unpack and Inspect, 1–7
Step 10 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC, 1–16
Step 2 – Install Optional Hardware Accessories, 1–8
Step 3 – Become Familiar with Available Communication Ports, 1–9
Step 4 – Install Micro-Graphic Panel, 1–10
Step 5 – Install the Programming Software and Develop a Project, 1–11
Step 6 – Connect C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to Computer, 1–12
Step 7 – Provide Power to the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel, 1–13

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 i–5
Index

Step 8 – Accessing the C-more Micro-Graphic Panel Setup Screens, 1–14


Step 9 – Choose C-more Micro-Graphic Panel to PLC Protocol & Cables, 1–15

R
Replacement Parts, 9–3
DC Power Connector Part No. EA-MG-DC-CON, 9–3
Function Keys Label Inserts Part No. EA-MG-S3ML-FKL, 9–3
Keypad Bezel 1 Gasket Part No. EA-MG-BZ1-GSK, 9–2
Keypad Bezel 1 Mounting Clips Part No. EA-MG-BZ1-BRK, 9–2
Keypad Bezel 2 Gasket Part No. EA-MG-BZ2-GSK, 9–3
Keypad Bezel 2 Mounting Clips Part No. EA-MG-BZ2-BRK, 9–3
Panel Gasket Part No. EA-MG-S3ML-GSK, 9–2
Panel Mounting Clips Part No. EA-MG-S3ML-BRK, 9–2
Replacement Parts at a Glance, 9–2
Replacement Parts Overview, 9–2
RS-422A/RS-485A Multi-Drop Wiring Diagram Examples, 6–40
Runtime Errors, B–2
Introduction, B–2
Panel Errors, B–2

S
Safety Guidelines, 4–2
Plan for Safety, 4–2
Screen Overlay, 3–21
Clear, 3–21
Dimensions, 3–21
EA-MG-COV-CL, 3–21
Installation, 3–21
Serial Number and Date Code formats, 1–6
Serial Port with DC Power Adapter, 3–18
Available PLC Protocols, 3–20
Dimensions, 3–18
EA-MG-SP1, 3–18
Installed onto a Panel with 20-Button Keypad Bezel, 3–20
Panel Overall Depth with Adapter Installed, 3–18
PLC Serial Communications Port 1, 3–20

i–6 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10
Index

Specifications, 3–19
Wiring Diagram, 3–18
Setting – Hourglass, 5–13
Specifications, 2–3
System Setup Screens, 5–2
Exit, 5–17
Information Menu, 5–6
Extensions, 5–6
Memory, 5–6
Protocol, 5–6
Versions, 5–6
Introduction, 5–2
Information, 5–2
Setting, 5–2
Test Menu, 5–2
Setting – Backlight, 5–8, 5–9
Setting – Beep, 5–10
Setting – Calibration, 5–11
Setting – Clear User Memory, 5–12
Setting – LCD Contrast, 5–7
Setting – Reset to Factory Default, 5–12
Setting Menu, 5–7
Setup Menu, 5–5
Exit, 5–5
Information, 5–5
Setting, 5–5
Test Menu, 5–5
System Setup Screens Flowchart, 5–4

T
Technical Support, 1–2
Test Menu, 5–14
Buzzer Test, 5–16
PLC Enquiry Test, 5–16
Serial Port1 - Loop Back Test, 5–14
Serial Port2 - Loop Back Test, 5–15
Touch Panel Test, 5–17

®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10 i–7
Index

Troubleshooting, 8–2
Display is Blank, 8–2
Display is Dim, 8–3
Electrical Noise Problems, 8–10
Lost Firmware – Red ‘Update Mode’ Screen Displayed, 8–4
Micro-Graphic Panel does not Power up, 8–2
Powered from 12-24 VDC, 8–2
Powered from 5 VDC, 8–2
No Communications between Panel and PC, 8–5
No Communications between Panel and PLC, 8–7
No User Program, 8–3
Panel Runtime Errors, 8–9
PLC Protocol Error Codes, 8–8
PLC Protocol Error Example, 8–8

U
User Manual Introduction, 1–2

W
Wiring Guidelines, 4–5
Panel Powered from a DC Power Adapter, 4–6
Wiring Diagrams, 4–6
Panel Powered from Direct LOGIC PLC, 4–5
Providing Power to the Micro-Graphic Panel, 4–5

i–8 ®
EA1-MG-USER-M Hardware User Manual, 2nd Ed. Rev. B, 09/10

You might also like